Use INTERNAL_FIELD for symbols.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #include <unistd.h>
89
90 #ifdef USE_GTK
91 #include "gtkutil.h"
92 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
93 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
94 #endif
95 #endif
96
97 #ifdef USE_LUCID
98 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
99 #endif
100
101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
102 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
103 #define HACK_EDITRES
104 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
105 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
106
107 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
108
109 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
110 #if defined USE_MOTIF
111 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
112 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
113 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
114
115 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
116 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
119 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
120 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
122 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
123 #ifndef XtNpickTop
124 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
125 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
126 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
127 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
128
129 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
130
131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
132 #include "widget.h"
133 #ifndef XtNinitialState
134 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
135 #endif
136 #endif
137
138 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
139
140 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
141 #ifdef USE_XIM
142 int use_xim = 1;
143 #else
144 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
145 #endif
146
147 \f
148
149 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
150 start. */
151
152 static int any_help_event_p;
153
154 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
155 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
159
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161
162 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
163 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
164 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
165 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166
167 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168
169 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
170 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
171 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
172 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173
174 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175
176 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177
178 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179
180 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181
182 static struct {
183 struct frame *f;
184 int eventtype;
185 } pending_event_wait;
186
187 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
188 /* The application context for Xt use. */
189 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
190 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
191
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
196
197 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
198 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
199 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200
201 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202
203 /* Mouse movement.
204
205 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
206 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
207 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
208 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209
210 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211
212 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
213 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
214 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
215 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
216 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
217 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
218 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
219 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
220 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
221 is off. */
222
223 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224
225 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
226 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228
229 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230
231 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
232 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
233 an ordinary motion.
234
235 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
236 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
237 event. */
238
239 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240
241 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
242 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
243 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
244 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
245 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
246 it's somewhat accurate. */
247
248 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249
250 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251
252 static Time last_user_time;
253
254 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
255 events. */
256
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258
259 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
260
261 static int x_noop_count;
262
263 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
264
265 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
266 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
267
268 #ifdef USE_GTK
269 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
270 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
271
272 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
273 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
274 #endif
275
276 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
277 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
278
279 enum xembed_info
280 {
281 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
282 };
283
284 enum xembed_message
285 {
286 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
287 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
288 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
289 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
290 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
291 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
292 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
294
295 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
296 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
297 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
298 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
299 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
300 };
301
302 /* Used in x_flush. */
303
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
306 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
307 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
308 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
309 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
310
311 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
312 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
313 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
314 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
315 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
316 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
317 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
319 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
320 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
321 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
322 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
323 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
324 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
325 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
326 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
327 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
329 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
330 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
331 enum text_cursor_kinds);
332
333 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
334 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
335 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
336 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
337 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
338 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
339 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
340 enum scroll_bar_part *,
341 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
342 Time *);
343 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
344 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
345 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
346 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
347 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
348 int *, struct input_event *);
349 #ifdef USE_GTK
350 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
351 #endif
352 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
353 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
354 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
355 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
356 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
357 static void x_initialize (void);
358
359
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
361
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
364 {
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
369
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
372 {
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
377 }
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
381 }
382
383
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
390
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392
393 \f
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
397
398 #if 0
399
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
402
403 struct record
404 {
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
407 };
408
409 struct record event_record[100];
410
411 int event_record_index;
412
413 void
414 record_event (char *locus, int type)
415 {
416 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
417 event_record_index = 0;
418
419 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
420 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
421 event_record_index++;
422 }
423
424 #endif /* 0 */
425
426
427 \f
428 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
429
430 struct x_display_info *
431 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
432 {
433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
434
435 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
436 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
437 return dpyinfo;
438
439 return 0;
440 }
441
442 static Window
443 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
444 {
445 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
446 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
447 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
448
449 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
450 {
451 Window root;
452 Window *children;
453 unsigned int nchildren;
454
455 win = wi;
456 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
457 XFree (children);
458 }
459
460 return win;
461 }
462
463 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
464
465 void
466 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
467 {
468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
469 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
470 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
471 double alpha = 1.0;
472 double alpha_min = 1.0;
473 unsigned long opac;
474 Window parent;
475
476 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
477 alpha = f->alpha[0];
478 else
479 alpha = f->alpha[1];
480
481 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
482 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
483 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
484 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
485
486 if (alpha < 0.0)
487 return;
488 else if (alpha > 1.0)
489 alpha = 1.0;
490 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
491 alpha = alpha_min;
492
493 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
494
495 x_catch_errors (dpy);
496
497 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
498 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
499 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
500 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
501
502 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
503 if (parent != None)
504 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
506 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
507
508 /* return unless necessary */
509 {
510 unsigned char *data;
511 Atom actual;
512 int rc, format;
513 unsigned long n, left;
514
515 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
516 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
517 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
518 &data);
519
520 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
521 {
522 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
523 XFree ((void *) data);
524 if (value == opac)
525 {
526 x_uncatch_errors ();
527 return;
528 }
529 }
530 }
531
532 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
533 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
534 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
535 x_uncatch_errors ();
536 }
537
538 int
539 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
540 {
541 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
542 }
543
544 int
545 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
546 {
547 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
548 }
549
550 \f
551 /***********************************************************************
552 Starting and ending an update
553 ***********************************************************************/
554
555 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
556 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
557 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
558 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
559 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
560
561 static void
562 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
563 {
564 /* Nothing to do. */
565 }
566
567
568 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
569 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
570 position of W. */
571
572 static void
573 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
574 {
575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
576 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
577
578 updated_window = w;
579 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
580
581 BLOCK_INPUT;
582
583 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
584 {
585 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
586 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
587
588 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
589 highlighting. */
590 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
591 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
592 }
593
594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
595 }
596
597
598 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
599
600 static void
601 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
602 {
603 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
604 struct face *face;
605
606 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
607 if (face)
608 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
609 face->foreground);
610
611 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
612 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
613 }
614
615 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
616
617 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
618 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
619
620 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
621 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
622 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
623
624 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
625 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
626 here. */
627
628 static void
629 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
630 {
631 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame)));
632
633 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
634 {
635 BLOCK_INPUT;
636
637 if (cursor_on_p)
638 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
639 output_cursor.vpos,
640 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
641
642 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
643 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
644
645 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
646 }
647
648 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
649 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
650 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
651 {
652 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
653 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
654 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
655 }
656
657 updated_window = NULL;
658 }
659
660
661 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
662 update_end. */
663
664 static void
665 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
666 {
667 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
668 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
669
670 #ifndef XFlush
671 BLOCK_INPUT;
672 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
674 #endif
675 }
676
677
678 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
679 complete update has been performed. The global variable
680 updated_window is not available here. */
681
682 static void
683 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
684 {
685 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
686 {
687 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
688
689 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
690 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
691 {
692 BLOCK_INPUT;
693 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
695 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
697 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
699 }
700 }
701 }
702
703
704 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
705 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
706 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
707 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
708 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
709 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
710
711 static void
712 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
713 {
714 struct window *w = updated_window;
715 struct frame *f;
716 int width, height;
717
718 eassert (w);
719
720 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
721 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
722
723 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
724 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
725 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
726 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
727 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
728 overhead is very small. */
729 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
730 && desired_row->full_width_p
731 && (f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame)),
732 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
733 width != 0)
734 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
735 height > 0))
736 {
737 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
738
739 BLOCK_INPUT;
740 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
741 0, y, width, height, False);
742 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
743 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
744 y, width, height, False);
745 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
746 }
747 }
748
749 static void
750 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
751 {
752 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
753 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
754 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
755 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
756 struct face *face = p->face;
757
758 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
759 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
760
761 if (!p->overlay_p)
762 {
763 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
764
765 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
766 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
767 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
768 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
769 if (face->stipple)
770 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
771 else
772 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
773
774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
775 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
776 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
777 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
778 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
779 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
780 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
781 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
782 {
783 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
784
785 if (sb_width > 0)
786 {
787 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
788 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
789 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
790
791 if (bx < 0)
792 {
793 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
794 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
795 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
796 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
797 bx = bar_area_x;
798 if (bx >= 0)
799 {
800 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
801
802 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
804 row->y));
805 ny = row->visible_height;
806 }
807 }
808 else
809 {
810 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
811 {
812 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
813 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
814 }
815 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
817 }
818 }
819 }
820 #endif
821 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
822 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
823
824 if (!face->stipple)
825 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
826 }
827
828 if (p->which)
829 {
830 char *bits;
831 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
832 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
833 XGCValues gcv;
834
835 if (p->wd > 8)
836 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
837 else
838 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
839
840 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
841 by the server. */
842 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
843 (p->cursor_p
844 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
845 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
846 : face->foreground),
847 face->background, depth);
848
849 if (p->overlay_p)
850 {
851 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
852 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
853 bits, p->wd, p->h,
854 1, 0, 1);
855 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
856 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
857 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
858 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
859 }
860
861 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
862 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
863 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
864
865 if (p->overlay_p)
866 {
867 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
868 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
869 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
870 }
871 }
872
873 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
874 }
875
876 \f
877
878 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
879 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
880 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
881 rarely happens). */
882
883 static void
884 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
885 {
886 }
887
888 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
889 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
890
891 static void
892 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
893 {
894 }
895
896 \f
897 /***********************************************************************
898 Glyph display
899 ***********************************************************************/
900
901
902
903 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
904 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
905 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
906 int);
907 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
911 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
912 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
916 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
917 unsigned long *, double, int);
918 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
919 double, int, unsigned long);
920 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
921 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
922 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
923 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
925 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
926 int, int, int);
927 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
928 int, int, int, int, int, int,
929 XRectangle *);
930 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
932 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
933
934 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
935 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
936 #endif
937
938
939 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
940 face. */
941
942 static void
943 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
944 {
945 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
946 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
947 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
948 && !s->cmp)
949 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
950 else
951 {
952 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
953 XGCValues xgcv;
954 unsigned long mask;
955
956 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
957 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
958
959 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
960 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
962 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
963 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966
967 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
968 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
969 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
970 {
971 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
972 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
973 }
974
975 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
976 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
977 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
978
979 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
980 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
981 mask, &xgcv);
982 else
983 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
984 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
985
986 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
987 }
988 }
989
990
991 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
992
993 static void
994 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
995 {
996 int face_id;
997 struct face *face;
998
999 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1000 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1001 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1002 if (face == NULL)
1003 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1004
1005 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1006 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1007 else
1008 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1009 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1010 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1011
1012 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1014 else
1015 {
1016 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1017 except for FONT. */
1018 XGCValues xgcv;
1019 unsigned long mask;
1020
1021 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1024 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1025
1026 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1027 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1028 mask, &xgcv);
1029 else
1030 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1031 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1032
1033 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1034
1035 }
1036 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1037 }
1038
1039
1040 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1041 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1042 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1043
1044 static inline void
1045 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1046 {
1047 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1048 }
1049
1050
1051 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1052 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1053 pattern. */
1054
1055 static inline void
1056 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1057 {
1058 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1059
1060 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1061 {
1062 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1063 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 }
1065 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1066 {
1067 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1068 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1069 }
1070 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1071 {
1072 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1073 s->stippled_p = 0;
1074 }
1075 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1076 {
1077 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1078 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1079 }
1080 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1081 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1082 {
1083 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1085 }
1086 else
1087 {
1088 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1090 }
1091
1092 /* GC must have been set. */
1093 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1094 }
1095
1096
1097 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1098 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1099
1100 static inline void
1101 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1102 {
1103 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1104 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1105
1106 if (n > 0)
1107 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1108 s->num_clips = n;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1113 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1114 the area of SRC. */
1115
1116 static void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1118 {
1119 XRectangle r;
1120
1121 r.x = src->x;
1122 r.width = src->width;
1123 r.y = src->y;
1124 r.height = src->height;
1125 dst->clip[0] = r;
1126 dst->num_clips = 1;
1127 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1128 }
1129
1130
1131 /* RIF:
1132 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1133
1134 static void
1135 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1136 {
1137 if (s->cmp == NULL
1138 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1139 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1140 {
1141 struct font_metrics metrics;
1142
1143 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1144 {
1145 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1146 struct font *font = s->font;
1147 int i;
1148
1149 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1150 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1151 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1156
1157 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1158 }
1159 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1160 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1161 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1162 }
1163 else if (s->cmp)
1164 {
1165 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1166 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1167 }
1168 }
1169
1170
1171 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1172
1173 static inline void
1174 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1175 {
1176 XGCValues xgcv;
1177 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1178 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1179 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1180 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1181 }
1182
1183
1184 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1185 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1186 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1187 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1188 contains the first component of a composition. */
1189
1190 static void
1191 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1192 {
1193 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1194 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1195 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1196 {
1197 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1198
1199 if (s->stippled_p)
1200 {
1201 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1202 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1204 s->y + box_line_width,
1205 s->background_width,
1206 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1207 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1208 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1209 }
1210 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1211 || s->font_not_found_p
1212 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1213 || force_p)
1214 {
1215 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1216 s->background_width,
1217 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1218 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1219 }
1220 }
1221 }
1222
1223
1224 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1225
1226 static void
1227 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1228 {
1229 int i, x;
1230
1231 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1232 of S to the right of that box line. */
1233 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1234 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1235 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1236 else
1237 x = s->x;
1238
1239 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1240 loaded. */
1241 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1242 {
1243 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1244 {
1245 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1246 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1247 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1248 s->height - 1);
1249 x += g->pixel_width;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 else
1253 {
1254 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1256 int y;
1257
1258 if (font->vertical_centering)
1259 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1260
1261 y = s->ybase - boff;
1262 if (s->for_overlaps
1263 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1264 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1265 else
1266 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1268 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1269 }
1270 }
1271
1272 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1273
1274 static void
1275 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1276 {
1277 int i, j, x;
1278 struct font *font = s->font;
1279
1280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1281 of S to the right of that box line. */
1282 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1284 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1285 else
1286 x = s->x;
1287
1288 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1289 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1290 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1291 this composition. */
1292
1293 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1294 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1295 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1296 {
1297 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1298 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1299 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1300 }
1301 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1302 {
1303 int y = s->ybase;
1304
1305 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1306 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1307 space on the left or right. */
1308 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1309 {
1310 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1311 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1312
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1314 if (s->face->overstrike)
1315 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1316 }
1317 }
1318 else
1319 {
1320 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1321 Lisp_Object glyph;
1322 int y = s->ybase;
1323 int width = 0;
1324
1325 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1326 {
1327 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1328 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1329 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1330 else
1331 {
1332 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1333
1334 if (j < i)
1335 {
1336 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1337 if (s->face->overstrike)
1338 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1339 x += width;
1340 }
1341 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1342 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1343 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1344 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1345 if (s->face->overstrike)
1346 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1347 x += wadjust;
1348 j = i + 1;
1349 width = 0;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 if (j < i)
1353 {
1354 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1355 if (s->face->overstrike)
1356 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1357 }
1358 }
1359 }
1360
1361
1362 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1363
1364 static void
1365 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1366 {
1367 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1368 XChar2b char2b[8];
1369 int x, i, j;
1370
1371 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1372 of S to the right of that box line. */
1373 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1374 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1375 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1376 else
1377 x = s->x;
1378
1379 s->char2b = char2b;
1380
1381 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1382 {
1383 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1384 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1385
1386 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1387 {
1388 if (len > 0
1389 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1390 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1391 >= 1))
1392 {
1393 Lisp_Object acronym
1394 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1395 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1396 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1397 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1398 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1399 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1400 }
1401 }
1402 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1403 {
1404 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1405 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1406 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1407 str = buf;
1408 }
1409
1410 if (str)
1411 {
1412 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1413 unsigned code;
1414
1415 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1416 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1417 {
1418 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1419 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1420 }
1421 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1422 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1423 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1424 0);
1425 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1426 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1427 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1428 0);
1429 }
1430 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1431 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1432 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1433 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1434 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1435 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1436 }
1437 }
1438
1439 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1440
1441 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1442 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1443 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1444 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1445
1446 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1447
1448 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1449 cannot be determined. */
1450
1451 static struct frame *
1452 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1453 {
1454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1455 Lisp_Object tail;
1456 struct frame *f;
1457
1458 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1459
1460 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1461 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1462 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1463 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1464 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1465 widget = XtParent (widget);
1466
1467 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1468 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1469 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1470 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1471 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1472 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1473 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1474 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1475 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1476 return f;
1477
1478 abort ();
1479 }
1480
1481 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1482 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1483 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1484 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1485 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1486 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1487
1488 int
1489 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1490 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1491 {
1492 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1493 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1494 }
1495
1496 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1497
1498
1499 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1501
1502 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1503 {
1504 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1505 sizeof (Screen *)},
1506 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1507 sizeof (Colormap)}
1508 };
1509
1510
1511 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1512 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1513
1514 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1515
1516
1517 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1518
1519 DPY is the display we are working on.
1520
1521 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1522 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1523 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1524 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1525
1526 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1527 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1528
1529 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1530 we allocated the color or not.
1531
1532 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1533
1534 static Boolean
1535 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1536 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1537 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1538 {
1539 Screen *screen;
1540 Colormap cmap;
1541 Pixel pixel;
1542 String color_name;
1543 XColor color;
1544
1545 if (*nargs != 2)
1546 {
1547 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1548 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1549 "XtToolkitError",
1550 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1551 return False;
1552 }
1553
1554 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1555 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1556 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1557
1558 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1559 {
1560 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1561 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1562 }
1563 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1564 {
1565 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1566 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1567 }
1568 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1569 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1570 {
1571 pixel = color.pixel;
1572 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1573 }
1574 else
1575 {
1576 String params[1];
1577 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1578
1579 params[0] = color_name;
1580 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1581 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1582 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1583 params, &nparams);
1584 return False;
1585 }
1586
1587 if (to->addr != NULL)
1588 {
1589 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1590 {
1591 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1592 return False;
1593 }
1594
1595 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1596 }
1597 else
1598 {
1599 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1600 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1601 }
1602
1603 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1604 return True;
1605 }
1606
1607
1608 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1609 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1610 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1611
1612 APP is the application context in which we work.
1613
1614 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1615 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1616 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1617
1618 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1619
1620 static void
1621 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1622 Cardinal *nargs)
1623 {
1624 if (*nargs != 2)
1625 {
1626 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1627 "XtToolkitError",
1628 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1629 NULL, NULL);
1630 }
1631 else if (closure != NULL)
1632 {
1633 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1634 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1635 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1636 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1637 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1638 }
1639 }
1640
1641
1642 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1643
1644
1645 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1646 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1647 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1648 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1649
1650 static const XColor *
1651 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1652 {
1653 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1654
1655 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1656 {
1657 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1658 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1659 int i;
1660
1661 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1662 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1663 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1664
1665 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1666 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1667
1668 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1669 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1670 }
1671
1672 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1673 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1674 }
1675
1676
1677 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1678 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1679
1680 void
1681 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1682 {
1683 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1684
1685 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1686 {
1687 int i;
1688 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1689 {
1690 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1691 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1692 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1693 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1694 }
1695 }
1696 else
1697 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1698 }
1699
1700
1701 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1702 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1703
1704 void
1705 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1706 {
1707 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1708 }
1709
1710
1711 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1712 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1713 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1714 allocated. */
1715
1716 static int
1717 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1718 {
1719 int rc;
1720
1721 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1722 if (rc == 0)
1723 {
1724 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1725 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1726 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1727 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1728 int nearest, i;
1729 int max_color_delta = 255;
1730 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1731 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1732 int ncells;
1733 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1734
1735 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1736 {
1737 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1738 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1739 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1740 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1741
1742 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1743 {
1744 nearest = i;
1745 nearest_delta = delta;
1746 }
1747 }
1748
1749 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1750 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1751 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1752 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1753 }
1754 else
1755 {
1756 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1757 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1758 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1759 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1760 XColor *cached_color;
1761
1762 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1763 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1764 (cached_color->red != color->red
1765 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1766 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1767 {
1768 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1769 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1770 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1771 }
1772 }
1773
1774 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1775 if (rc)
1776 register_color (color->pixel);
1777 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1778
1779 return rc;
1780 }
1781
1782
1783 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1784 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1785 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1786 allocated. */
1787
1788 int
1789 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1790 {
1791 gamma_correct (f, color);
1792 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1793 }
1794
1795
1796 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1797 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1798 get color reference counts right. */
1799
1800 unsigned long
1801 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1802 {
1803 XColor color;
1804
1805 color.pixel = pixel;
1806 BLOCK_INPUT;
1807 x_query_color (f, &color);
1808 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1810 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1811 register_color (pixel);
1812 #endif
1813 return color.pixel;
1814 }
1815
1816
1817 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1818 boosted.
1819
1820 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1821 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1822 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1823 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1824 use an additional additive factor.
1825
1826 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1827 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1828 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1829
1830
1831 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1832 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1833 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1834 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1835 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1836 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1837
1838 static int
1839 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1840 {
1841 XColor color, new;
1842 long bright;
1843 int success_p;
1844
1845 /* Get RGB color values. */
1846 color.pixel = *pixel;
1847 x_query_color (f, &color);
1848
1849 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1850 eassert (factor >= 0);
1851 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1852 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1853 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1854
1855 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1856 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1857
1858 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1859 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1860 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1861 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1862 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1863 {
1864 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1865 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1866 /* The additive adjustment. */
1867 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1868
1869 if (factor < 1)
1870 {
1871 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1872 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1873 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1874 }
1875 else
1876 {
1877 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1878 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1879 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1880 }
1881 }
1882
1883 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1884 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1885 if (success_p)
1886 {
1887 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1888 {
1889 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1890 delta to the RGB values. */
1891 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1892
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1896 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1897 }
1898 else
1899 success_p = 1;
1900 *pixel = new.pixel;
1901 }
1902
1903 return success_p;
1904 }
1905
1906
1907 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1908 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1909 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1910 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1911 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1912 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1913
1914 static void
1915 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1916 {
1917 XGCValues xgcv;
1918 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1919 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1920 unsigned long pixel;
1921 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1922 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1923 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1924 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1925
1926 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1927 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1928
1929 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1930 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1931 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1932 if (relief->gc
1933 && relief->allocated_p)
1934 {
1935 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1936 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1937 }
1938
1939 /* Allocate new color. */
1940 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1941 pixel = background;
1942 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1943 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1944 {
1945 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1946 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1947 }
1948
1949 if (relief->gc == 0)
1950 {
1951 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1952 mask |= GCStipple;
1953 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1954 }
1955 else
1956 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1957 }
1958
1959
1960 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1961
1962 static void
1963 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1964 {
1965 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1966 unsigned long color;
1967
1968 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1969 color = s->face->box_color;
1970 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1971 && s->img->pixmap
1972 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1973 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1974 else
1975 {
1976 XGCValues xgcv;
1977
1978 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1979 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1980 color = xgcv.background;
1981 }
1982
1983 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1984 || color != di->relief_background)
1985 {
1986 di->relief_background = color;
1987 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1988 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1989 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1990 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1991 }
1992 }
1993
1994
1995 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1996 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1997 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1998 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1999 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2000 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2001 when drawing. */
2002
2003 static void
2004 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2005 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2006 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2007 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2008 {
2009 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2010 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2011 int i;
2012 GC gc;
2013
2014 if (raised_p)
2015 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2016 else
2017 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2018 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2019
2020 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2021 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2022 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2023 corner pixels. */
2024
2025 /* Top. */
2026 if (top_p)
2027 {
2028 if (width == 1)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2030 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2031 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2032
2033 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2034 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2035 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2036 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2037 }
2038
2039 /* Left. */
2040 if (left_p)
2041 {
2042 if (width == 1)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2044
2045 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2046 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2047
2048 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051 }
2052
2053 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2054 if (raised_p)
2055 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2056 else
2057 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2058 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2059
2060 if (width > 1)
2061 {
2062 /* Outermost top line. */
2063 if (top_p)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2066 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2067
2068 /* Outermost left line. */
2069 if (left_p)
2070 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2071 }
2072
2073 /* Bottom. */
2074 if (bot_p)
2075 {
2076 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2077 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2078 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2079 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2080 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2081 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2082 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2083 }
2084
2085 /* Right. */
2086 if (right_p)
2087 {
2088 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2089 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2090 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2091 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2092 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2093 }
2094
2095 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2096 }
2097
2098
2099 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2100 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2101 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2102 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2103 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2104 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2105
2106 static void
2107 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2108 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2109 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2110 {
2111 XGCValues xgcv;
2112
2113 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2115 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2116
2117 /* Top. */
2118 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2119 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2120
2121 /* Left. */
2122 if (left_p)
2123 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2124 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2125
2126 /* Bottom. */
2127 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2128 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2129
2130 /* Right. */
2131 if (right_p)
2132 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2133 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2134
2135 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2136 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2137 }
2138
2139
2140 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2141
2142 static void
2143 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2144 {
2145 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2146 int left_p, right_p;
2147 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2148 XRectangle clip_rect;
2149
2150 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2151 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2152 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2153
2154 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2155 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2156 ? s->first_glyph
2157 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2158
2159 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2160 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2161 left_x = s->x;
2162 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2163 ? last_x - 1
2164 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2165 top_y = s->y;
2166 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2167
2168 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2169 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2170 && (s->prev == NULL
2171 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2172 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2173 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2174 && (s->next == NULL
2175 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2176
2177 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2178
2179 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2180 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2181 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2182 else
2183 {
2184 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2185 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2186 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2187 }
2188 }
2189
2190
2191 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2192
2193 static void
2194 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2195 {
2196 int x = s->x;
2197 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2198
2199 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2200 right of that line. */
2201 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2202 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2203 && s->slice.x == 0)
2204 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2205
2206 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2207 by that margin. */
2208 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2209 x += s->img->hmargin;
2210 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2211 y += s->img->vmargin;
2212
2213 if (s->img->pixmap)
2214 {
2215 if (s->img->mask)
2216 {
2217 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2218 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2219 trust on the shape extension to be available
2220 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2221 manually. */
2222 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2223 | GCFunction);
2224 XGCValues xgcv;
2225 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2226
2227 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2228 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2229 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2230 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2231 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242 }
2243 else
2244 {
2245 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2246
2247 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2248 image_rect.x = x;
2249 image_rect.y = y;
2250 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2251 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2252 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2253 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2254 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2255 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2256
2257 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2258 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2259 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2260 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2261 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2262 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2263 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2264 {
2265 int relief = s->img->relief;
2266 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2267 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2268 x - relief, y - relief,
2269 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2270 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2271 }
2272 }
2273 }
2274 else
2275 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2276 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2277 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2278 }
2279
2280
2281 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2282
2283 static void
2284 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2285 {
2286 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2287 int extra_x, extra_y;
2288 XRectangle r;
2289 int x = s->x;
2290 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2291
2292 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2293 right of that line. */
2294 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2295 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2296 && s->slice.x == 0)
2297 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2298
2299 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2300 by that margin. */
2301 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += s->img->hmargin;
2303 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2304 y += s->img->vmargin;
2305
2306 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2307 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2308 {
2309 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2310 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2311 }
2312 else
2313 {
2314 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2315 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2316 }
2317
2318 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2319 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2320 {
2321 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2322 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2323 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2324 {
2325 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2326 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2327 }
2328 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2329 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2330 }
2331
2332 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2333 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2334 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2335 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2336
2337 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2338 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2339 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2340 s->slice.y == 0,
2341 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2342 s->slice.x == 0,
2343 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2344 &r);
2345 }
2346
2347
2348 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2349
2350 static void
2351 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2352 {
2353 int x = 0;
2354 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2355
2356 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2357 right of that line. */
2358 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2359 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2360 && s->slice.x == 0)
2361 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2362
2363 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2364 by that margin. */
2365 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2366 x += s->img->hmargin;
2367 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2368 y += s->img->vmargin;
2369
2370 if (s->img->pixmap)
2371 {
2372 if (s->img->mask)
2373 {
2374 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2375 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2376 trust on the shape extension to be available
2377 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2378 manually. */
2379 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2380 | GCFunction);
2381 XGCValues xgcv;
2382
2383 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2384 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2385 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2386 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2387 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2388
2389 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2390 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2391 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2392 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2393 }
2394 else
2395 {
2396 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2397 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2398 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2399
2400 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2401 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2402 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2403 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2404 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2405 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2406 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2407 {
2408 int r = s->img->relief;
2409 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2410 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2411 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2412 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2413 }
2414 }
2415 }
2416 else
2417 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2418 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2419 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2420 }
2421
2422
2423 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2424 give the rectangle to draw. */
2425
2426 static void
2427 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2428 {
2429 if (s->stippled_p)
2430 {
2431 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2432 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2433 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2434 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2435 }
2436 else
2437 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2438 }
2439
2440
2441 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2442
2443 s->y
2444 s->x +-------------------------
2445 | s->face->box
2446 |
2447 | +-------------------------
2448 | | s->img->margin
2449 | |
2450 | | +-------------------
2451 | | | the image
2452
2453 */
2454
2455 static void
2456 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2457 {
2458 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2459 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2460 int height;
2461 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2462
2463 height = s->height;
2464 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2465 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2466 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2467 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2468
2469 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2470 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2471 flickering. */
2472 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2473 if (height > s->slice.height
2474 || s->img->hmargin
2475 || s->img->vmargin
2476 || s->img->mask
2477 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2478 || s->width != s->background_width)
2479 {
2480 if (s->img->mask)
2481 {
2482 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2483 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2484 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2485 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2486 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2487
2488 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2489 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2490 s->background_width,
2491 s->height, depth);
2492
2493 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2494 pixmap. */
2495 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2496
2497 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2498 if (s->stippled_p)
2499 {
2500 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2501 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2502 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2503 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2504 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2505 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2506 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2507 }
2508 else
2509 {
2510 XGCValues xgcv;
2511 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2512 &xgcv);
2513 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2514 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2515 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2516 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2517 }
2518 }
2519 else
2520 {
2521 int x = s->x;
2522 int y = s->y;
2523
2524 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2525 && s->slice.x == 0)
2526 x += box_line_hwidth;
2527
2528 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2529 y += box_line_vwidth;
2530
2531 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2532 }
2533
2534 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2535 }
2536
2537 /* Draw the foreground. */
2538 if (pixmap != None)
2539 {
2540 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2541 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2542 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2543 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2544 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2545 }
2546 else
2547 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2548
2549 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2550 if (s->img->relief
2551 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2552 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2553 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2554 }
2555
2556
2557 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2558
2559 static void
2560 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2561 {
2562 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2563
2564 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2565 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2566 {
2567 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2568 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2569 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2570 int x = s->x;
2571
2572 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2573 {
2574 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2575
2576 if (x < left_x)
2577 {
2578 background_width -= left_x - x;
2579 x = left_x;
2580 }
2581 }
2582 else
2583 {
2584 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2585 stretch glyph. */
2586 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2587
2588 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2589 background_width -= x - right_x;
2590 x += background_width;
2591 }
2592 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2593 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2594 x -= width;
2595
2596 /* Draw cursor. */
2597 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2598
2599 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2600 if (width < background_width)
2601 {
2602 int y = s->y;
2603 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2604 XRectangle r;
2605 GC gc;
2606
2607 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2608 x += width;
2609 else
2610 x = s->x;
2611 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2612 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2613 {
2614 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2615 gc = s->gc;
2616 }
2617 else
2618 gc = s->face->gc;
2619
2620 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2621 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2622
2623 if (s->face->stipple)
2624 {
2625 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2626 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2627 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2628 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2629 }
2630 else
2631 {
2632 XGCValues xgcv;
2633 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2634 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2635 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2636 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2637 }
2638 }
2639 }
2640 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2641 {
2642 int background_width = s->background_width;
2643 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2644
2645 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2646 except for header line and mode line. */
2647 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2648 {
2649 background_width -= left_x - x;
2650 x = left_x;
2651 }
2652 if (background_width > 0)
2653 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2654 }
2655
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 }
2658
2659 /*
2660 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2661
2662 x0 wave_length = 2
2663 --
2664 y0 * * * * *
2665 |* * * * * * * * *
2666 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2667
2668 */
2669
2670 static void
2671 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2672 {
2673 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2674 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2675 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2676
2677 dx = wave_length;
2678 dy = wave_height - 1;
2679 x0 = s->x;
2680 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2681 width = s->width;
2682 xmax = x0 + width;
2683
2684 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2685
2686 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2687 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2688
2689 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2690 return;
2691
2692 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2693
2694 /* Draw the waves */
2695
2696 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2697 x2 = x1 + dx;
2698 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2699 y1 = y2 = y0;
2700
2701 if (odd)
2702 y1 += dy;
2703 else
2704 y2 += dy;
2705
2706 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2707 abort ();
2708
2709 while (x1 <= xmax)
2710 {
2711 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2712 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2713 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2714 odd = !odd;
2715 }
2716
2717 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2718 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2719 }
2720
2721
2722 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2723
2724 static void
2725 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2726 {
2727 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2728
2729 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2730 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2731 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2732 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2733 {
2734 int width;
2735 struct glyph_string *next;
2736
2737 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2738 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2739 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2740 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2741 {
2742 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2744 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2745 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2746 else
2747 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2748 next->num_clips = 0;
2749 }
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2753 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2754
2755 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2756 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2757 if (!s->for_overlaps
2758 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2759 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2760 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2761
2762 {
2763 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2765 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2766 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2767 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2768 }
2769 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2770 && !s->clip_tail
2771 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2772 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2773 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2774 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2775 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2776 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2777 else
2778 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2779
2780 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2781 {
2782 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2783 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2784 break;
2785
2786 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2787 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2788 break;
2789
2790 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2791 if (s->for_overlaps)
2792 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2793 else
2794 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2795 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2796 break;
2797
2798 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2799 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2800 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2801 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2802 else
2803 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2804 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2805 break;
2806
2807 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2808 if (s->for_overlaps)
2809 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2810 else
2811 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2812 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2813 break;
2814
2815 default:
2816 abort ();
2817 }
2818
2819 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2820 {
2821 /* Draw underline. */
2822 if (s->face->underline_p)
2823 {
2824 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2825 {
2826 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2827 x_draw_underwave (s);
2828 else
2829 {
2830 XGCValues xgcv;
2831 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2833 x_draw_underwave (s);
2834 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2835 }
2836 }
2837 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2838 {
2839 unsigned long thickness, position;
2840 int y;
2841
2842 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2843 {
2844 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2845 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2846 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2847 }
2848 else
2849 {
2850 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2851 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2852 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2853 else
2854 thickness = 1;
2855 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2856 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2857 else
2858 {
2859 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2860 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2861 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2862 specs, and its default is
2863
2864 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2865 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2866
2867 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2868 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2869 position = s->font->underline_position;
2870 else if (s->font)
2871 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2872 else
2873 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2874 }
2875 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2876 }
2877 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2878 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2879 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2880 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2881 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2882 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2883 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2884 s->underline_position = position;
2885 y = s->ybase + position;
2886 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2887 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2888 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2889 else
2890 {
2891 XGCValues xgcv;
2892 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2893 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2895 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2897 }
2898 }
2899 }
2900 /* Draw overline. */
2901 if (s->face->overline_p)
2902 {
2903 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2904
2905 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2906 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2907 s->width, h);
2908 else
2909 {
2910 XGCValues xgcv;
2911 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2912 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2913 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2914 s->width, h);
2915 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2916 }
2917 }
2918
2919 /* Draw strike-through. */
2920 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2921 {
2922 unsigned long h = 1;
2923 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2924
2925 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2926 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2927 s->width, h);
2928 else
2929 {
2930 XGCValues xgcv;
2931 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2932 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2933 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2934 s->width, h);
2935 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2936 }
2937 }
2938
2939 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2940 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2941 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2942
2943 if (s->prev)
2944 {
2945 struct glyph_string *prev;
2946
2947 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2948 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2949 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2950 {
2951 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2952 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2953 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2954
2955 prev->hl = s->hl;
2956 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2957 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2958 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2959 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2960 else
2961 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2962 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2963 prev->hl = save;
2964 prev->num_clips = 0;
2965 }
2966 }
2967
2968 if (s->next)
2969 {
2970 struct glyph_string *next;
2971
2972 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2973 if (next->hl != s->hl
2974 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2975 {
2976 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2977 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2978 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2979
2980 next->hl = s->hl;
2981 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2982 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2983 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2984 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2985 else
2986 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2987 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2988 next->hl = save;
2989 next->num_clips = 0;
2990 }
2991 }
2992 }
2993
2994 /* Reset clipping. */
2995 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2996 s->num_clips = 0;
2997 }
2998
2999 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3000
3001 static void
3002 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
3003 {
3004 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3005 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3006 x, y, width, height,
3007 x + shift_by, y);
3008 }
3009
3010 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3011 for X frames. */
3012
3013 static void
3014 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3015 {
3016 abort ();
3017 }
3018
3019
3020 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3021 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3022
3023 void
3024 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3025 {
3026 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3027 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3028 }
3029
3030
3031 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3032
3033 static void
3034 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3035 {
3036 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3037 longer visible. */
3038 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3039 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3040 output_cursor.x = -1;
3041
3042 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3043 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3044 BLOCK_INPUT;
3045
3046 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3047
3048 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3049 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3050 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3051
3052 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3053 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3054 redisplay, do it here. */
3055 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3056 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3057 #endif
3058
3059 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3060
3061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3062 }
3063
3064
3065 \f
3066 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3067
3068 static void
3069 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3070 {
3071 BLOCK_INPUT;
3072
3073 {
3074 #ifdef USE_GTK
3075 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3076 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3077 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3078 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3079 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3080 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3081 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3082 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3083 do { \
3084 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3085 cairo_fill (cr); \
3086 } \
3087 while (0)
3088 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3089 GdkGCValues vals;
3090 GdkGC *gc;
3091 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3092 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3093 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3094 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3095 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3096 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3097 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3098 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3099 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3100 GC gc;
3101
3102 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3103 pixels into background pixels. */
3104 {
3105 XGCValues values;
3106
3107 values.function = GXxor;
3108 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3109 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3110
3111 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3112 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3113 }
3114 #endif
3115 {
3116 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3117 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3118 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3119 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3120 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3121 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3122 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3123
3124 int width;
3125
3126 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3127 edge it is next to. */
3128 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3129 {
3130 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3131 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3132 break;
3133
3134 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3135 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3136 break;
3137
3138 default:
3139 break;
3140 }
3141
3142 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3143
3144 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3145 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3146 {
3147 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3148 flash_left,
3149 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3150 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3151 width, flash_height);
3152 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3153 flash_left,
3154 (height - flash_height
3155 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3156 width, flash_height);
3157
3158 }
3159 else
3160 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3161 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3162 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3163 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3164
3165 x_flush (f);
3166
3167 {
3168 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3169 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3170
3171 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3172 available. */
3173 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3174 {
3175 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3176 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3177
3178 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3179 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3180 break;
3181
3182 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3183 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3184
3185 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3186 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3187 }
3188 }
3189
3190 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3191 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3192 {
3193 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3194 flash_left,
3195 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3196 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3197 width, flash_height);
3198 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3199 flash_left,
3200 (height - flash_height
3201 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3202 width, flash_height);
3203 }
3204 else
3205 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3206 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3207 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3208 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3209
3210 #ifdef USE_GTK
3211 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3212 cairo_destroy (cr);
3213 #else
3214 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3215 #endif
3216 #undef XFillRectangle
3217 #else
3218 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3219 #endif
3220 x_flush (f);
3221 }
3222 }
3223
3224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3225 }
3226
3227
3228 static void
3229 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3230 {
3231 BLOCK_INPUT;
3232 if (invisible)
3233 {
3234 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3235 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3236 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3237 }
3238 else
3239 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3240 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3241 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3243 }
3244
3245
3246 /* Make audible bell. */
3247
3248 static void
3249 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3250 {
3251 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3252 {
3253 if (visible_bell)
3254 XTflash (f);
3255 else
3256 {
3257 BLOCK_INPUT;
3258 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3259 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3260 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3261 }
3262 }
3263 }
3264
3265 \f
3266 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3267 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3268 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3269 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3270
3271 static void
3272 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3273 {
3274 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3275 }
3276
3277
3278 \f
3279 /***********************************************************************
3280 Line Dance
3281 ***********************************************************************/
3282
3283 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3284 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3285
3286 static void
3287 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3288 {
3289 abort ();
3290 }
3291
3292
3293 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3294
3295 static void
3296 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3297 {
3298 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame));
3299 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3300
3301 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3302 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3303 fringe of W. */
3304 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3305
3306 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3307 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3308 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3309 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3310 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3311 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3312 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3313 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3314 {
3315 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3316
3317 if (sb_width > 0)
3318 {
3319 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3320 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3321 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3322
3323 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3324 {
3325 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3326 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3327 }
3328 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3329 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 #endif
3333
3334 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3335 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3336 bottom_y = y + height;
3337
3338 if (to_y < from_y)
3339 {
3340 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3341 line at the bottom. */
3342 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3343 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3344 else
3345 height = run->height;
3346 }
3347 else
3348 {
3349 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3350 at the bottom. */
3351 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3352 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3353 else
3354 height = run->height;
3355 }
3356
3357 BLOCK_INPUT;
3358
3359 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3360 updated_window = w;
3361 x_clear_cursor (w);
3362
3363 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3364 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3365 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3366 x, from_y,
3367 width, height,
3368 x, to_y);
3369
3370 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3371 }
3372
3373
3374 \f
3375 /***********************************************************************
3376 Exposure Events
3377 ***********************************************************************/
3378
3379 \f
3380 static void
3381 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3382 {
3383 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3384 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3385 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3386 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3387 BLOCK_INPUT;
3388 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3389 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3390 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3391 because of this (bug#9310). */
3392 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3393 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3394 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3395 x_uncatch_errors ();
3396 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3397 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3398 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3399 }
3400
3401 static void
3402 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3403 {
3404 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3405 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3406 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3407 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3408 BLOCK_INPUT;
3409 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3410 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3411 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3412 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3413 x_uncatch_errors ();
3414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3415 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3416 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3417 }
3418
3419 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3420 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3421 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3422 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3423 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3424
3425 static void
3426 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3427 {
3428 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3429
3430 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3431 {
3432 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3433 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3434 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3435
3436 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3437 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3438
3439 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3440 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3441 else
3442 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3443 }
3444
3445 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3446 }
3447
3448 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3449 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3450 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3451
3452 static void
3453 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3454 {
3455 if (type == FocusIn)
3456 {
3457 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3458 {
3459 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3460 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3461
3462 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3463 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3464 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3465 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3466 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3467 {
3468 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3469 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3470 }
3471 }
3472
3473 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3474
3475 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3476 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3477 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3478 #endif
3479 }
3480 else if (type == FocusOut)
3481 {
3482 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3483
3484 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3485 {
3486 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3487 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3488 }
3489
3490 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3491 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3492 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3493 #endif
3494 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3495 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3496 }
3497 }
3498
3499 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3500 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3501
3502 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3503
3504 static void
3505 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3506 {
3507 struct frame *frame;
3508
3509 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3510 if (! frame)
3511 return;
3512
3513 switch (event->type)
3514 {
3515 case EnterNotify:
3516 case LeaveNotify:
3517 {
3518 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3519 int focus_state
3520 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3521
3522 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3523 && event->xcrossing.focus
3524 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3525 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3526 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3527 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3528 }
3529 break;
3530
3531 case FocusIn:
3532 case FocusOut:
3533 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3534 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3535 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3536 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3537 break;
3538
3539 case ClientMessage:
3540 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3541 {
3542 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3543 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3544 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3545 }
3546 break;
3547 }
3548 }
3549
3550
3551 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3552 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3553
3554 void
3555 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3556 {
3557 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3558 }
3559 #endif
3560
3561 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3562 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3563 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3564
3565 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3566 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3567 the appropriate X display info. */
3568
3569 static void
3570 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3571 {
3572 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3573 }
3574
3575 static void
3576 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3577 {
3578 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3579
3580 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3581 {
3582 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3583 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3584 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3585 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3586 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3587 {
3588 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3589 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3590 }
3591 }
3592 else
3593 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3594
3595 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3596 {
3597 if (old_highlight)
3598 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3599 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3600 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3601 }
3602 }
3603
3604
3605 \f
3606 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3607
3608 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3609 static void
3610 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3611 {
3612 int min_code, max_code;
3613 KeySym *syms;
3614 int syms_per_code;
3615 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3616
3617 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3618 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3619 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3620 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3621 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3622
3623 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3624
3625 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3626 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3627 &syms_per_code);
3628 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3629
3630 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3631 Alt keysyms are on. */
3632 {
3633 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3634 int found_alt_or_meta;
3635
3636 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3637 {
3638 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3639 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3640 {
3641 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3642
3643 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3644 if (code == 0)
3645 continue;
3646
3647 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3648 {
3649 int code_col;
3650
3651 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3652 {
3653 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3654
3655 switch (sym)
3656 {
3657 case XK_Meta_L:
3658 case XK_Meta_R:
3659 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3660 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3661 break;
3662
3663 case XK_Alt_L:
3664 case XK_Alt_R:
3665 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3666 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3667 break;
3668
3669 case XK_Hyper_L:
3670 case XK_Hyper_R:
3671 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3672 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3673 code_col = syms_per_code;
3674 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3675 break;
3676
3677 case XK_Super_L:
3678 case XK_Super_R:
3679 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3680 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3681 code_col = syms_per_code;
3682 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3683 break;
3684
3685 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3686 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3687 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3688 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3689 code_col = syms_per_code;
3690 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3691 break;
3692 }
3693 }
3694 }
3695 }
3696 }
3697 }
3698
3699 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3700 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3701 {
3702 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3703 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3704 }
3705
3706 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3707 make them just meta, not alt. */
3708 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3709 {
3710 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3711 }
3712
3713 XFree ((char *) syms);
3714 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3715 }
3716
3717 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3718 Emacs uses. */
3719
3720 int
3721 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3722 {
3723 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3724 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3725 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3726 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3727 Lisp_Object tem;
3728
3729 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3730 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3731 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3732 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3733 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3734 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3735 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3736 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3737
3738 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3739 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3740 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3741 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3742 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3743 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3744 }
3745
3746 static int
3747 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3748 {
3749 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3750 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3751 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3752 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3753
3754 Lisp_Object tem;
3755
3756 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3757 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3758 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3759 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3760 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3761 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3762 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3763 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3764
3765
3766 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3767 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3768 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3769 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3770 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3771 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3775
3776 char *
3777 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3778 {
3779 char *value;
3780
3781 BLOCK_INPUT;
3782 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3783 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3784
3785 return value;
3786 }
3787
3788
3789 \f
3790 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3791
3792 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3793
3794 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3795 the mouse. */
3796
3797 static Lisp_Object
3798 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3799 {
3800 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3801 otherwise. */
3802 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3803 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3804 result->timestamp = event->time;
3805 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3806 event->state)
3807 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3808 ? up_modifier
3809 : down_modifier));
3810
3811 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3812 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3813 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3814 result->arg = Qnil;
3815 return Qnil;
3816 }
3817
3818 \f
3819 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3820 The input handler calls this.
3821
3822 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3823 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3824 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3825 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3826
3827 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3828 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3829
3830 static int
3831 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3832 {
3833 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3834 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3835 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3836
3837 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3838 return 0;
3839
3840 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3841 {
3842 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3843 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3844 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3845 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3846 return 1;
3847 }
3848
3849
3850 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3851 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3852 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3853 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3854 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3855 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3856 {
3857 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3858 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3859 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3860 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3861 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3862 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3863 return 1;
3864 }
3865
3866 return 0;
3867 }
3868
3869 \f
3870 /************************************************************************
3871 Mouse Face
3872 ************************************************************************/
3873
3874 static void
3875 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3876 {
3877 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3878 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3879 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3880 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3881 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3882 }
3883
3884
3885
3886 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3887 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3888
3889 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3890 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3891 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3892 position on the scroll bar.
3893
3894 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3895 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3896 the mouse is over.
3897
3898 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3899 was at this position.
3900
3901 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3902
3903 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3904 movement. */
3905
3906 static void
3907 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3908 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3909 Time *timestamp)
3910 {
3911 FRAME_PTR f1;
3912
3913 BLOCK_INPUT;
3914
3915 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3916 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3917 else
3918 {
3919 Window root;
3920 int root_x, root_y;
3921
3922 Window dummy_window;
3923 int dummy;
3924
3925 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3926
3927 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3928 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3929 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3930 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3931 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3932
3933 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3934
3935 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3936 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3937 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3938
3939 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3940 &root,
3941
3942 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3943 a different screen. */
3944 &dummy_window,
3945
3946 /* The position on that root window. */
3947 &root_x, &root_y,
3948
3949 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3950 &dummy, &dummy,
3951
3952 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3953 we don't care. */
3954 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3955
3956 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3957 containing the pointer. */
3958 {
3959 Window win, child;
3960 int win_x, win_y;
3961 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3962
3963 win = root;
3964
3965 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3966 structure is changing at the same time this function
3967 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3968
3969 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3970
3971 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3972 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3973 {
3974 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3975 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3976 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3977
3978 /* From-window, to-window. */
3979 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3980
3981 /* From-position, to-position. */
3982 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3983
3984 /* Child of win. */
3985 &child);
3986 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3987 }
3988 else
3989 {
3990 while (1)
3991 {
3992 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3993
3994 /* From-window, to-window. */
3995 root, win,
3996
3997 /* From-position, to-position. */
3998 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3999
4000 /* Child of win. */
4001 &child);
4002
4003 if (child == None || child == win)
4004 break;
4005 #ifdef USE_GTK
4006 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4007 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4008 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4009 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4010 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
4011 break;
4012 #endif
4013 win = child;
4014 parent_x = win_x;
4015 parent_y = win_y;
4016 }
4017
4018 /* Now we know that:
4019 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4020 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4021 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4022 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4023 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4024 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4025 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4026 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4027 never use them in that case.) */
4028
4029 #ifdef USE_GTK
4030 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4031 want the edit window. */
4032 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4033 #else
4034 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4035 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4036 #endif
4037
4038 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4039 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4040 on the frame. */
4041 if (f1 != NULL
4042 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4043 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4044 f1 = NULL;
4045 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4046 }
4047
4048 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4049 f1 = 0;
4050
4051 x_uncatch_errors ();
4052
4053 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4054 if (! f1)
4055 {
4056 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4057
4058 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4059
4060 if (bar)
4061 {
4062 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4063 win_x = parent_x;
4064 win_y = parent_y;
4065 }
4066 }
4067
4068 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4069 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4070
4071 if (f1)
4072 {
4073 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4074 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4075 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4076 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4077 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4078 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4079 the frame are divided into. */
4080
4081 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4082 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4083
4084 *bar_window = Qnil;
4085 *part = 0;
4086 *fp = f1;
4087 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4088 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4089 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4090 }
4091 }
4092 }
4093
4094 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4095 }
4096
4097
4098 \f
4099 /***********************************************************************
4100 Scroll bars
4101 ***********************************************************************/
4102
4103 /* Scroll bar support. */
4104
4105 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4106 manages it.
4107 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4108 bits. */
4109
4110 static struct scroll_bar *
4111 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4112 {
4113 Lisp_Object tail;
4114
4115 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4116 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4117 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4118
4119 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4120 {
4121 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4122
4123 frame = XCAR (tail);
4124 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4125 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4126 abort ();
4127
4128 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4129 continue;
4130
4131 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4132 right window ID. */
4133 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4134 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4135 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4136 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4137 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4138 condemned = Qnil,
4139 ! NILP (bar));
4140 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4141 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4142 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4143 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4144 }
4145
4146 return NULL;
4147 }
4148
4149
4150 #if defined USE_LUCID
4151
4152 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4153 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4154
4155 static Widget
4156 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4157 {
4158 Lisp_Object tail;
4159
4160 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4161 {
4162 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4163 {
4164 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4165 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4166
4167 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4168 return menu_bar;
4169 }
4170 }
4171
4172 return NULL;
4173 }
4174
4175 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4176
4177 \f
4178 /************************************************************************
4179 Toolkit scroll bars
4180 ************************************************************************/
4181
4182 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4183
4184 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4185 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4186 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4187 struct scroll_bar *);
4188 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4189 int, int, int);
4190
4191
4192 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4193 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4194
4195 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4196
4197 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4198
4199 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4200
4201 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4202 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4203
4204 #ifndef USE_GTK
4205 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4206
4207 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4208
4209 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4210
4211 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4212 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4213 to avoid jerkiness. */
4214
4215 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4216
4217 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4218 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4219 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4220 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4221
4222 static void
4223 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4224 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4225 {
4226 int scroll_bar_p;
4227 const char *end_action;
4228
4229 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4230 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4231 end_action = "Release";
4232 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4233 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4234 end_action = "EndScroll";
4235 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4236
4237 if (scroll_bar_p
4238 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4239 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4240 {
4241 struct window *w;
4242
4243 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4244 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4245 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4246
4247 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (WVAR (w, vertical_scroll_bar))->dragging))
4248 {
4249 XSCROLL_BAR (WVAR (w, vertical_scroll_bar))->dragging = Qnil;
4250 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4251 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4252 }
4253 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4254 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4255
4256 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4257 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4258 }
4259 }
4260 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4261
4262 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4263 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4264
4265 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4266 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4267
4268
4269 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4270 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4271 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4272 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4273
4274 static void
4275 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4276 {
4277 XEvent event;
4278 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4279 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4280 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame));
4281 ptrdiff_t i;
4282
4283 BLOCK_INPUT;
4284
4285 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4286 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4287 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4288 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4289 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4290 ev->format = 32;
4291
4292 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4293 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4294 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4295 into that array in the event. */
4296 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4297 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4298 break;
4299
4300 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4301 {
4302 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4303 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4304 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4305 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4306 scroll_bar_windows =
4307 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4308 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4309 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4310 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4311 }
4312
4313 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4314 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4315 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4316 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4317 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4318 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4319
4320 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4321 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4322 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4323 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4324 #endif
4325
4326 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4327 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4328 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4329 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4331 }
4332
4333
4334 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4335 in *IEVENT. */
4336
4337 static void
4338 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4339 {
4340 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4341 Lisp_Object window;
4342 struct window *w;
4343
4344 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4345 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4346
4347 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4348
4349 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4350 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4351 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4352 #ifdef USE_GTK
4353 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4354 #else
4355 ievent->timestamp =
4356 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame))));
4357 #endif
4358 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4359 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4360 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4361 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4362 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4363 }
4364
4365
4366 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4367
4368 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4369
4370 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4371
4372
4373 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4374 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4375 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4376
4377 static void
4378 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4379 {
4380 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4381 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4382 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4383
4384 switch (cs->reason)
4385 {
4386 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4387 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4388 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4389 break;
4390
4391 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4392 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4393 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4394 break;
4395
4396 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4397 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4398 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4399 break;
4400
4401 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4402 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4403 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4404 break;
4405
4406 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4407 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4408 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4409 break;
4410
4411 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4412 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4413 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4414 break;
4415
4416 case XmCR_DRAG:
4417 {
4418 int slider_size;
4419
4420 /* Get the slider size. */
4421 BLOCK_INPUT;
4422 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4423 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4424
4425 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4426 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4427 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4428 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4429 }
4430 break;
4431
4432 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4433 break;
4434 };
4435
4436 if (part >= 0)
4437 {
4438 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4439 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4440 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4441 }
4442 }
4443
4444 #elif defined USE_GTK
4445
4446 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4447 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4448
4449 static gboolean
4450 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4451 GtkScrollType scroll,
4452 gdouble value,
4453 gpointer user_data)
4454 {
4455 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4456 gdouble position;
4457 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4458 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4459 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4460
4461 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4462 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4463
4464
4465 switch (scroll)
4466 {
4467 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4468 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4469 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4470 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4471 {
4472 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4473 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4474 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4475 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4476 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4477 }
4478 break;
4479 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4480 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4481 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4482 break;
4483 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4484 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4485 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4486 break;
4487 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4488 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4489 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4490 break;
4491 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4492 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4493 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4494 break;
4495 }
4496
4497 if (part >= 0)
4498 {
4499 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4500 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4501 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4502 }
4503
4504 return FALSE;
4505 }
4506
4507 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4508
4509 static gboolean
4510 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4511 GdkEventButton *event,
4512 gpointer user_data)
4513 {
4514 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4515 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4516 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4517 {
4518 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4519 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4520 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4521 }
4522
4523 return FALSE;
4524 }
4525
4526
4527 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4528
4529 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4530 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4531 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4532 the thumb is. */
4533
4534 static void
4535 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4536 {
4537 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4538 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4539 float shown;
4540 int whole, portion, height;
4541 int part;
4542
4543 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4544 BLOCK_INPUT;
4545 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4546 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4547
4548 whole = 10000000;
4549 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4550
4551 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4552 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4553 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4554 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4555 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4556 bottom). */
4557 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4558 else
4559 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4560
4561 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4562 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4563 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4564 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4565 }
4566
4567
4568 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4569 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4570 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4571 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4572 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4573 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4574 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4575
4576 static void
4577 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4578 {
4579 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4580 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4581 int position = (long) call_data;
4582 Dimension height;
4583 int part;
4584
4585 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4586 BLOCK_INPUT;
4587 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4588 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4589
4590 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4591 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4592
4593 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4594 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4595 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4596 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4597 else
4598 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4599
4600 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4601 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4602 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4603 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4604 }
4605
4606 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4607
4608 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4609
4610 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4611 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4612
4613 #ifdef USE_GTK
4614 static void
4615 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4616 {
4617 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4618
4619 BLOCK_INPUT;
4620 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4621 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4622 scroll_bar_name);
4623 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4624 }
4625
4626 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4627
4628 static void
4629 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4630 {
4631 Window xwindow;
4632 Widget widget;
4633 Arg av[20];
4634 int ac = 0;
4635 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4636 unsigned long pixel;
4637
4638 BLOCK_INPUT;
4639
4640 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4641 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4642 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4643 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4644 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4645 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4646 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4648 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4649
4650 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4651 if (pixel != -1)
4652 {
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4654 ++ac;
4655 }
4656
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4659 {
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4662 }
4663
4664 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4665 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4666
4667 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4668 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4669 (XtPointer) bar);
4670 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4671 (XtPointer) bar);
4672 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4673 (XtPointer) bar);
4674 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4675 (XtPointer) bar);
4676 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4677 (XtPointer) bar);
4678 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4679 (XtPointer) bar);
4680 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4681 (XtPointer) bar);
4682
4683 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4684 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4685
4686 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4687 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4688 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4689 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4690
4691 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4692
4693 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4694 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4695 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4696 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4697 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4698 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4699 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4700 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4701
4702 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4703 if (pixel != -1)
4704 {
4705 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4706 ++ac;
4707 }
4708
4709 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4710 if (pixel != -1)
4711 {
4712 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4713 ++ac;
4714 }
4715
4716 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4717
4718 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4719 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4720 {
4721 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4722 if (pixel != -1)
4723 {
4724 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4725 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4726 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4727 pixel = -1;
4728 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4729 }
4730 }
4731 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4732 {
4733 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4734 if (pixel != -1)
4735 {
4736 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4737 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4738 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4739 pixel = -1;
4740 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4745 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4746 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4747 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4748 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4749 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4750 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4751 colors itself. */
4752 {
4753 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4754 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4755 ++ac;
4756 }
4757 else
4758 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4759 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4760 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4761 {
4762 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4763 the shadows. */
4764 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4765 ++ac;
4766
4767 /* Specify the colors. */
4768 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4769 if (pixel != -1)
4770 {
4771 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4772 ++ac;
4773 }
4774 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4775 if (pixel != -1)
4776 {
4777 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4778 ++ac;
4779 }
4780 }
4781 #endif
4782
4783 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4784 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4785
4786 {
4787 char const *initial = "";
4788 char const *val = initial;
4789 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4790 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4791 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4792 #endif
4793 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4794 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4795 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4796 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4797 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4798 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4799 }
4800 }
4801
4802 /* Define callbacks. */
4803 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4804 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4805 (XtPointer) bar);
4806
4807 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4808 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4809
4810 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4811
4812 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4813 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4814 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4815 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4816
4817 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4818 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4819 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4820 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4821
4822 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4823 }
4824 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4825
4826
4827 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4828 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4829
4830 #ifdef USE_GTK
4831 static void
4832 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4833 {
4834 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4835 }
4836
4837 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4838 static void
4839 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4840 int whole)
4841 {
4842 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4843 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4844 float top, shown;
4845
4846 BLOCK_INPUT;
4847
4848 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4849
4850 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4851 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4852 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4853 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4854 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4855 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4856 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4857 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4858 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4859 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4860 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4861 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4862 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4863 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4864 whole += portion;
4865
4866 if (whole <= 0)
4867 top = 0, shown = 1;
4868 else
4869 {
4870 top = (float) position / whole;
4871 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4872 }
4873
4874 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4875 {
4876 int size, value;
4877
4878 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4879 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4880 value. */
4881 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4882 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4883 size = max (size, 1);
4884
4885 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4886 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4887 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4888
4889 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4890 }
4891 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4892
4893 if (whole == 0)
4894 top = 0, shown = 1;
4895 else
4896 {
4897 top = (float) position / whole;
4898 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4899 }
4900
4901 {
4902 float old_top, old_shown;
4903 Dimension height;
4904 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4905 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4906 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4907 XtNheight, &height,
4908 NULL);
4909
4910 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4911 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4912 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4913 else
4914 top = old_top;
4915 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4916 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4917
4918 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4919 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4920 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4921 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4922 {
4923 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4924 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4925 else
4926 {
4927 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4928 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4929 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4930
4931 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4932 }
4933 }
4934 }
4935 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4936
4937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4938 }
4939 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4940
4941 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4942
4943
4944 \f
4945 /************************************************************************
4946 Scroll bars, general
4947 ************************************************************************/
4948
4949 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4950 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4951 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4952 scroll bar. */
4953
4954 static struct scroll_bar *
4955 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4956 {
4957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame));
4958 struct scroll_bar *bar
4959 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4960
4961 BLOCK_INPUT;
4962
4963 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4964 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4965 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4966 {
4967 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4968 unsigned long mask;
4969 Window window;
4970
4971 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4972 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4973 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4974
4975 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4976 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4977 | ExposureMask);
4978 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4979
4980 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4981
4982 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4983 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4984 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4985 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4986 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4987 left, top, width,
4988 window_box_height (w), False);
4989
4990 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4991 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4992 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4993 top,
4994 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4995 height,
4996 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4997 0,
4998 CopyFromParent,
4999 CopyFromParent,
5000 CopyFromParent,
5001 /* Attributes. */
5002 mask, &a);
5003 bar->x_window = window;
5004 }
5005 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5006
5007 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5008 bar->top = top;
5009 bar->left = left;
5010 bar->width = width;
5011 bar->height = height;
5012 bar->start = 0;
5013 bar->end = 0;
5014 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5015 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5016
5017 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5018 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5019 bar->prev = Qnil;
5020 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5021 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5022 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5023
5024 /* Map the window/widget. */
5025 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5026 {
5027 #ifdef USE_GTK
5028 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5029 bar->x_window,
5030 top,
5031 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5032 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5033 max (height, 1));
5034 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5035 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5036 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5037 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5038 top,
5039 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5040 max (height, 1), 0);
5041 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5042 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5043 }
5044 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5045 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5046 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5047
5048 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5049 return bar;
5050 }
5051
5052
5053 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054
5055 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5056
5057 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5058 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5059 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5060 events.)
5061
5062 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5063 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5064 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5065 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5066 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5067
5068 static void
5069 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5070 {
5071 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5072 Window w = bar->x_window;
5073 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5074 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5075
5076 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5077 if (! rebuild
5078 && start == bar->start
5079 && end == bar->end)
5080 return;
5081
5082 BLOCK_INPUT;
5083
5084 {
5085 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5086 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5087 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5088
5089 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5090 the distance between start and end. */
5091 {
5092 int length = end - start;
5093
5094 if (start < 0)
5095 start = 0;
5096 else if (start > top_range)
5097 start = top_range;
5098 end = start + length;
5099
5100 if (end < start)
5101 end = start;
5102 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5103 end = top_range;
5104 }
5105
5106 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5107 bar->start = start;
5108 bar->end = end;
5109
5110 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5111 if (end > top_range)
5112 end = top_range;
5113
5114 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5115 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5116 that many pixels tall. */
5117 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5118
5119 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5120 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5121 if (0 < start)
5122 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5123 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5124 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5125 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5126 inside_width, start,
5127 False);
5128
5129 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5130 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5131 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5132 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5133
5134 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5135 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5136 /* x, y, width, height */
5137 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5138 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5139 inside_width, end - start);
5140
5141 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5142 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5143 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5144 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5145
5146 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5147 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5148 if (end < inside_height)
5149 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5150 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5151 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5152 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5153 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5154 False);
5155
5156 }
5157
5158 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5159 }
5160
5161 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5162
5163 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5164 nil. */
5165
5166 static void
5167 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5168 {
5169 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5170 BLOCK_INPUT;
5171
5172 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5173 #ifdef USE_GTK
5174 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5175 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5176 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5177 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5178 #else
5179 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5180 #endif
5181
5182 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5183 WVAR (XWINDOW (bar->window), vertical_scroll_bar) = Qnil;
5184
5185 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5186 }
5187
5188
5189 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5190 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5191 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5192 create one. */
5193
5194 static void
5195 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5196 {
5197 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame));
5198 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5199 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5200 int window_y, window_height;
5201 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5202 int fringe_extended_p;
5203 #endif
5204
5205 /* Get window dimensions. */
5206 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5207 top = window_y;
5208 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5209 height = window_height;
5210
5211 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5212 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5213
5214 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5215 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5216 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5217 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5218 else
5219 sb_width = width;
5220
5221 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5222 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5223 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5224 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5225 else
5226 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5227 #else
5228 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5229 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5230 else
5231 sb_left = left;
5232 #endif
5233
5234 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5235 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5236 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5237 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5238 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5239 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5240 else
5241 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5242 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5243 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5244 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5245 #endif
5246
5247 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5248 if (NILP (WVAR (w, vertical_scroll_bar)))
5249 {
5250 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5251 {
5252 BLOCK_INPUT;
5253 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5254 if (fringe_extended_p)
5255 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5256 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5257 else
5258 #endif
5259 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5260 left, top, width, height, False);
5261 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5262 }
5263
5264 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5265 }
5266 else
5267 {
5268 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5269 unsigned int mask = 0;
5270
5271 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (WVAR (w, vertical_scroll_bar));
5272
5273 BLOCK_INPUT;
5274
5275 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5276 mask |= CWX;
5277 if (top != bar->top)
5278 mask |= CWY;
5279 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5280 mask |= CWWidth;
5281 if (height != bar->height)
5282 mask |= CWHeight;
5283
5284 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5285
5286 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5287 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5288 {
5289 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5290 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5291 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5292 {
5293 if (fringe_extended_p)
5294 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5295 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5296 else
5297 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5298 left, top, width, height, False);
5299 }
5300 #ifdef USE_GTK
5301 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5302 bar->x_window,
5303 top,
5304 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5305 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5306 max (height, 1));
5307 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5308 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5309 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5310 top,
5311 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5312 max (height, 1), 0);
5313 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5314 }
5315 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5316
5317 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5318 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5319 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5320 {
5321 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5322 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5323 height, False);
5324 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5325 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5326 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5327 height, False);
5328 }
5329
5330 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5331 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5332 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5333 example. */
5334 {
5335 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5336 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5337 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5338 {
5339 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5340 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5341 left + area_width - rest, top,
5342 rest, height, False);
5343 else
5344 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5345 left, top, rest, height, False);
5346 }
5347 }
5348
5349 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5350 if (mask)
5351 {
5352 XWindowChanges wc;
5353
5354 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5355 wc.y = top;
5356 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5357 wc.height = height;
5358 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5359 mask, &wc);
5360 }
5361
5362 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5363
5364 /* Remember new settings. */
5365 bar->left = sb_left;
5366 bar->top = top;
5367 bar->width = sb_width;
5368 bar->height = height;
5369
5370 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5371 }
5372
5373 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5374 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5375
5376 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5377 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5378 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5379 dragged. */
5380 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5381 {
5382 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5383
5384 if (whole == 0)
5385 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5386 else
5387 {
5388 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5389 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5390 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5391 }
5392 }
5393 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394
5395 XSETVECTOR (WVAR (w, vertical_scroll_bar), bar);
5396 }
5397
5398
5399 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5400 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5401 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5402 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5403 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5404 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5405 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5406
5407 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5408 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5409 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5410
5411 static void
5412 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5413 {
5414 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5415 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5416 {
5417 Lisp_Object bar;
5418 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5419 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5420 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5421 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5422 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5423 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5424 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5425 }
5426 }
5427
5428
5429 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5430 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5431
5432 static void
5433 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5434 {
5435 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5436 struct frame *f;
5437
5438 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5439 if (NILP (WVAR (window, vertical_scroll_bar)))
5440 abort ();
5441
5442 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (WVAR (window, vertical_scroll_bar));
5443
5444 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5445 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5446 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5447 {
5448 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5449 the lists. */
5450 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), WVAR (window, vertical_scroll_bar)))
5451 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5452 return;
5453 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5454 WVAR (window, vertical_scroll_bar)))
5455 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5456 else
5457 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5458 one or the other! */
5459 abort ();
5460 }
5461 else
5462 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5463
5464 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5465 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5466
5467 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5468 bar->prev = Qnil;
5469 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5470 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5471 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5472 }
5473
5474 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5475 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5476
5477 static void
5478 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5479 {
5480 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5481
5482 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5483
5484 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5485 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5486 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5487
5488 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5489 {
5490 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5491
5492 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5493
5494 next = b->next;
5495 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5496 }
5497
5498 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5499 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5500 }
5501
5502
5503 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5504 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5505 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5506
5507 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5508 mark bits. */
5509
5510 static void
5511 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5512 {
5513 Window w = bar->x_window;
5514 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5515 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5516 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5517
5518 BLOCK_INPUT;
5519
5520 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5521
5522 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5523 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5524 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5525 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5526
5527 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5528 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5529
5530 /* x, y, width, height */
5531 0, 0,
5532 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5533 bar->height - 1);
5534
5535 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5536 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5537 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5538 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5539
5540 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5541
5542 }
5543 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5544
5545 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5546 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5547
5548 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5549 mark bits. */
5550
5551
5552 static void
5553 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5554 {
5555 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5556 abort ();
5557
5558 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5559 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5560 emacs_event->modifiers
5561 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5562 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5563 event->xbutton.state)
5564 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5565 ? up_modifier
5566 : down_modifier));
5567 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5568 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5569 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5570 {
5571 int top_range
5572 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5573 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5574
5575 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5576 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5577
5578 if (y < bar->start)
5579 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5580 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5581 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5582 else
5583 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5584
5585 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5586 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5587 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5588 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5589 {
5590 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5591 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5592
5593 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5594 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5595 }
5596 #endif
5597
5598 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5599 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5600 }
5601 }
5602
5603 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5604
5605 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5606
5607 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5608 mark bits. */
5609
5610 static void
5611 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5612 {
5613 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WVAR (XWINDOW (bar->window), frame));
5614
5615 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5616
5617 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5618 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5619
5620 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5621 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5622 {
5623 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5624 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5625
5626 if (new_start != bar->start)
5627 {
5628 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5629
5630 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5631 }
5632 }
5633 }
5634
5635 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5636
5637 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5638 on the scroll bar. */
5639
5640 static void
5641 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5642 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5643 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5644 {
5645 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5646 Window w = bar->x_window;
5647 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5648 int win_x, win_y;
5649 Window dummy_window;
5650 int dummy_coord;
5651 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5652
5653 BLOCK_INPUT;
5654
5655 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5656 report that. */
5657 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5658
5659 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5660 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5661 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5662
5663 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5664 &win_x, &win_y,
5665
5666 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5667 &dummy_mask))
5668 ;
5669 else
5670 {
5671 int top_range
5672 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5673
5674 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5675
5676 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5677 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5678
5679 if (win_y < 0)
5680 win_y = 0;
5681 if (win_y > top_range)
5682 win_y = top_range;
5683
5684 *fp = f;
5685 *bar_window = bar->window;
5686
5687 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5688 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5689 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5690 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5691 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5692 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5693 else
5694 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5695
5696 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5697 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5698
5699 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5700 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5701 }
5702
5703 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5704
5705 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5706 }
5707
5708
5709 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5710 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5711 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5712 redraw them. */
5713
5714 static void
5715 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5716 {
5717 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5718 Lisp_Object bar;
5719
5720 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5721 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5722 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5723 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5724 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5725 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5726 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5727 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5728 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5729 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5730 }
5731
5732 \f
5733 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5734
5735 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5736 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5737 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5738 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5739
5740 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5741 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5742
5743 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5744
5745 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5746 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5747
5748 static int temp_index;
5749 static short temp_buffer[100];
5750
5751 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5752 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5753 temp_index = 0; \
5754 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5755
5756 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5757 on a particular display. */
5758
5759 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5760
5761 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5762 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5763 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5764 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5765
5766 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5767
5768 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5769 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5770 do \
5771 { \
5772 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5773 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5774 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5775 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5776 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5777 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5778 } \
5779 while (0)
5780 #endif
5781
5782 enum
5783 {
5784 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5785 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5786 X_EVENT_DROP
5787 };
5788
5789 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5790 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5791 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5792
5793 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5794 this event further.
5795 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5796
5797 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5798 static int
5799 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5800 {
5801 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5802 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5803 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5804 was created. */
5805
5806 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5807 event->xclient.window);
5808
5809 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5810 }
5811 #endif
5812
5813 #ifdef USE_GTK
5814 static int current_count;
5815 static int current_finish;
5816 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5817
5818 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5819 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5820 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5821 static GdkFilterReturn
5822 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5823 {
5824 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5825
5826 BLOCK_INPUT;
5827 if (current_count >= 0)
5828 {
5829 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5830
5831 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5832
5833 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5834 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5835 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5836 so we do it here. */
5837 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5838 && dpyinfo
5839 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5840 {
5841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5842 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5843 }
5844 #endif
5845
5846 if (! dpyinfo)
5847 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5848 else
5849 current_count +=
5850 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5851 current_hold_quit);
5852 }
5853 else
5854 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5855
5856 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5857
5858 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5859 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5860
5861 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5862 }
5863 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5864
5865
5866 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5867 enum xembed_message,
5868 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5869
5870 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5871
5872 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5873 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5874 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5875
5876 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5877
5878 static int
5879 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5880 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5881 {
5882 union {
5883 struct input_event ie;
5884 struct selection_input_event sie;
5885 } inev;
5886 int count = 0;
5887 int do_help = 0;
5888 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5889 struct frame *f = NULL;
5890 struct coding_system coding;
5891 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5892 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5893 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5894
5895 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5896
5897 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5898 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5899 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5900
5901 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5902 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5903
5904 switch (event.type)
5905 {
5906 case ClientMessage:
5907 {
5908 if (event.xclient.message_type
5909 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5910 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5911 {
5912 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5913 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5914 {
5915 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5916 could be the shell widget window
5917 if the frame has no title bar. */
5918 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5919 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5920 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5921 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5922 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5923 #endif
5924 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5925 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5926 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5927 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5928 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5929 needed.
5930
5931 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5932 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5933 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5934 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5935 Emacs. */
5936
5937 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5938 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5939 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5940 if (f)
5941 {
5942 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5943 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5944 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5945 x_catch_errors (d);
5946 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5947 /* The ICCCM says this is
5948 the only valid choice. */
5949 RevertToParent,
5950 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5951 /* This is needed to detect the error
5952 if there is an error. */
5953 XSync (d, False);
5954 x_uncatch_errors ();
5955 }
5956 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5957 #endif /* 0 */
5958 goto done;
5959 }
5960
5961 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5962 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5963 {
5964 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5965 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5966 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5967 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5968 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5969 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5970 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5971 session manager and one for this. */
5972 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5973 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5974 #endif
5975 {
5976 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5977 event.xclient.window);
5978 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5979 for a single Emacs process. */
5980 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5981 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5982 event.xclient.window,
5983 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5984 else if (f)
5985 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5986 event.xclient.window,
5987 0, 0);
5988 }
5989 goto done;
5990 }
5991
5992 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5993 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5994 {
5995 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5996 event.xclient.window);
5997 if (!f)
5998 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5999
6000 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6001 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6002 goto done;
6003 }
6004
6005 goto done;
6006 }
6007
6008 if (event.xclient.message_type
6009 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6010 {
6011 goto done;
6012 }
6013
6014 if (event.xclient.message_type
6015 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6016 {
6017 int new_x, new_y;
6018 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6019
6020 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6021 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6022
6023 if (f)
6024 {
6025 f->left_pos = new_x;
6026 f->top_pos = new_y;
6027 }
6028 goto done;
6029 }
6030
6031 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6032 if (event.xclient.message_type
6033 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6034 {
6035 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6036 if (f)
6037 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6038 &event, NULL);
6039 goto done;
6040 }
6041 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6042
6043 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6044 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6045 || (event.xclient.message_type
6046 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6047 {
6048 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6049 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6050 currently never do because we are interested in
6051 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6052 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6053 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6054 if (!f)
6055 goto OTHER;
6056 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6057 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6058 goto done;
6059 }
6060
6061 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6062 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6063 we construct an input_event. */
6064 if (event.xclient.message_type
6065 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6066 {
6067 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6068 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6069 goto done;
6070 }
6071 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6072
6073 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6074 if (event.xclient.message_type
6075 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6076 {
6077 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6078 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6079 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6080
6081 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6082 goto done;
6083 }
6084
6085 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6086
6087 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6088 if (!f)
6089 goto OTHER;
6090 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6091 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6092 }
6093 break;
6094
6095 case SelectionNotify:
6096 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6097 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6098 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6099 goto OTHER;
6100 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6101 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6102 break;
6103
6104 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6105 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6106 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6107 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6108 goto OTHER;
6109 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6110 {
6111 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6112
6113 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6114 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6115 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6116 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6117 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6118 }
6119 break;
6120
6121 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6122 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6123 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6124 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6125 goto OTHER;
6126 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6127 {
6128 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6129
6130 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6131 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6132 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6133 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6134 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6135 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6136 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6137 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6138 }
6139 break;
6140
6141 case PropertyNotify:
6142 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6143 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6144 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6145 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6146 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6147 {
6148 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6149 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6150 treat it as deiconified. */
6151 if (! f->async_iconified)
6152 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6153 f->async_visible = 1;
6154 f->async_iconified = 0;
6155 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6156 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6157 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6158 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6159 }
6160
6161 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6162 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6163 goto OTHER;
6164
6165 case ReparentNotify:
6166 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6167 if (f)
6168 {
6169 int x, y;
6170 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6171 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6172 f->left_pos = x;
6173 f->top_pos = y;
6174
6175 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6176 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6177 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6178
6179 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6180 }
6181 goto OTHER;
6182
6183 case Expose:
6184 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6185 if (f)
6186 {
6187 #ifdef USE_GTK
6188 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6189 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6190 event.xexpose.window,
6191 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6192 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6193 FALSE);
6194 #endif
6195 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6196 {
6197 f->async_visible = 1;
6198 f->async_iconified = 0;
6199 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6200 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6201 }
6202 else
6203 expose_frame (f,
6204 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6205 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6206 }
6207 else
6208 {
6209 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6210 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6211 #endif
6212 #if defined USE_LUCID
6213 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6214 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6215 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6216 {
6217 Widget widget
6218 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6219 if (widget)
6220 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6221 }
6222 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6223
6224 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6225 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6226 goto OTHER;
6227 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6228 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6229 event.xexpose.window);
6230
6231 if (bar)
6232 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6233 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6234 else
6235 goto OTHER;
6236 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6237 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6238 }
6239 break;
6240
6241 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6242 source area was obscured or not
6243 available. */
6244 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6245 if (f)
6246 {
6247 expose_frame (f,
6248 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6249 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6250 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6251 }
6252 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6253 else
6254 goto OTHER;
6255 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6256 break;
6257
6258 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6259 source area was completely
6260 available. */
6261 break;
6262
6263 case UnmapNotify:
6264 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6265 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6266 {
6267 tip_window = 0;
6268 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6269 }
6270
6271 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6272 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6273 the frame was deleted. */
6274 {
6275 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6276 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6277 display that won't ever be seen. */
6278 f->async_visible = 0;
6279 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6280 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6281 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6282 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6283 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6284 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6285 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6286 {
6287 f->async_iconified = 1;
6288
6289 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6290 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6291 }
6292 }
6293 goto OTHER;
6294
6295 case MapNotify:
6296 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6297 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6298 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6299 goto OTHER;
6300
6301 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6302 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6303 frame is visible. */
6304 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6305 if (f)
6306 {
6307 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6308 the frame's display structures.
6309 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6310 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6311 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6312 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6313 if (! f->async_iconified)
6314 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6315
6316 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6317 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6318 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6319 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6320
6321 f->async_visible = 1;
6322 f->async_iconified = 0;
6323 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6324
6325 if (f->iconified)
6326 {
6327 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6328 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6329 }
6330 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6331 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6332 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6333 to update the frame titles
6334 in case this is the second frame. */
6335 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6336
6337 #ifdef USE_GTK
6338 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6339 #endif
6340 }
6341 goto OTHER;
6342
6343 case KeyPress:
6344
6345 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6346 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6347
6348 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6349 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6350 if (popup_activated ())
6351 goto OTHER;
6352 #endif
6353
6354 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6355
6356 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6357 mouse highlighting. */
6358 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6359 && (f == 0
6360 || !EQ (FVAR (f, tool_bar_window), hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6361 {
6362 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6363 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6364 }
6365
6366 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6367 if (f == 0)
6368 {
6369 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6370 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6371 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6372 event.xkey.window);
6373 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6374 {
6375 widget = XtParent (widget);
6376 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6377 }
6378 }
6379 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6380
6381 if (f != 0)
6382 {
6383 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6384 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6385 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6386 his Emacs hang.
6387
6388 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6389 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6390 status_return even if the input is too long to
6391 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6392 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6393 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6394 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6395 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6396 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6397 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6398 int modifiers;
6399 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6400 Lisp_Object c;
6401
6402 #ifdef USE_GTK
6403 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6404 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6405 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6406 (see above). */
6407 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6408 #endif
6409
6410 event.xkey.state
6411 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6412 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6413 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6414
6415 /* This will have to go some day... */
6416
6417 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6418 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6419 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6420 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6421 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6422 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6423 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6424
6425 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6426 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6427 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6428 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6429 not it is combined with Meta. */
6430 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6431 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6432
6433 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6434 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6435 {
6436 Status status_return;
6437
6438 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6439 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6440 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6441 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6442 &status_return);
6443 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6444 {
6445 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6446 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6447 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6448 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6449 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6450 &status_return);
6451 }
6452 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6453 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6454 break;
6455 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6456 {
6457 keysym = NoSymbol;
6458 modifiers = 0;
6459 }
6460 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6461 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6462 abort ();
6463 }
6464 else
6465 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6466 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6467 &compose_status);
6468 #else
6469 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6470 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6471 &compose_status);
6472 #endif
6473
6474 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6475 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6476 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6477 break;
6478
6479 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6480 orig_keysym = keysym;
6481
6482 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6483 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6484 inev.ie.modifiers
6485 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6486 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6487
6488 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6489 translations to characters. */
6490 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6491 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6492 {
6493 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6494 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6495 goto done_keysym;
6496 }
6497
6498 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6499 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6500 {
6501 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6502 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6503 else
6504 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6505 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6506 goto done_keysym;
6507 }
6508
6509 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6510 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6511 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6512 Vx_keysym_table,
6513 Qnil),
6514 NATNUMP (c)))
6515 {
6516 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6517 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6518 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6519 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6520 goto done_keysym;
6521 }
6522
6523 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6524 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6525 || keysym == XK_Delete
6526 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6527 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6528 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6529 #endif
6530 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6531 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6532 #ifdef HPUX
6533 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6534 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6535 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6536 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6537 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6538 #endif
6539 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6540 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6541 #endif
6542 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6543 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6544 #endif
6545 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6546 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6547 #endif
6548 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6549 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6550 #endif
6551 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6552 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6553 #endif
6554 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6555 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6556 #endif
6557 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6558 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6559 #endif
6560 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6561 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6562 #endif
6563 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6564 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6565 #endif
6566 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6567 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6568 #endif
6569 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6570 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6571 #endif
6572 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6573 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6574 #endif
6575 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6576 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6577 #endif
6578 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6579 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6580 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6581 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6582 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6583 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6584 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6585 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6586 don't have real modifiers but
6587 should be treated similarly to
6588 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6589 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6590 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6591 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6592 #endif
6593 ))
6594 {
6595 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6596 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6597 key. */
6598 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6599 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6600 goto done_keysym;
6601 }
6602
6603 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6604 ptrdiff_t i;
6605 int nchars, len;
6606
6607 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6608 {
6609 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6610 nchars++;
6611 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6612 }
6613
6614 if (nchars < nbytes)
6615 {
6616 /* Decode the input data. */
6617
6618 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6619 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6620 we used just above and the locale. */
6621 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6622 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6623 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6624 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6625 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6626 gives us composition information. */
6627 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6628
6629 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6630 nbytes);
6631 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6632 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6633 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6634 nbytes = coding.produced;
6635 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6636 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6637 }
6638
6639 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6640 character events. */
6641 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6642 {
6643 int ch;
6644 if (nchars == nbytes)
6645 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6646 else
6647 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6648 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6649 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6650 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6651 inev.ie.code = ch;
6652 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6653 }
6654
6655 count += nchars;
6656
6657 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6658
6659 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6660 break;
6661 }
6662 }
6663 done_keysym:
6664 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6665 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6666 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6667 client. */
6668 break;
6669 #else
6670 goto OTHER;
6671 #endif
6672
6673 case KeyRelease:
6674 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6675 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6676 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6677 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6678 client. */
6679 break;
6680 #else
6681 goto OTHER;
6682 #endif
6683
6684 case EnterNotify:
6685 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6686 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6687
6688 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6689
6690 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6691 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6692
6693 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6694 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6695 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6696 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6697 #ifdef USE_GTK
6698 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6699 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6700 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6701 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6702 #endif
6703 goto OTHER;
6704
6705 case FocusIn:
6706 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6707 goto OTHER;
6708
6709 case LeaveNotify:
6710 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6711 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6712
6713 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6714 if (f)
6715 {
6716 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6717 {
6718 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6719 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6720 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6721 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6722 }
6723
6724 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6725 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6726 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6727 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6728 if (any_help_event_p)
6729 do_help = -1;
6730 }
6731 #ifdef USE_GTK
6732 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6733 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6734 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6735 #endif
6736 goto OTHER;
6737
6738 case FocusOut:
6739 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6740 goto OTHER;
6741
6742 case MotionNotify:
6743 {
6744 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6745 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6746 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6747
6748 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6749 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6750 f = last_mouse_frame;
6751 else
6752 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6753
6754 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6755 {
6756 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6757 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6758 }
6759
6760 #ifdef USE_GTK
6761 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6762 f = 0;
6763 #endif
6764 if (f)
6765 {
6766
6767 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6768 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6769 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6770 {
6771 Lisp_Object window;
6772
6773 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6774 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6775 0, 0);
6776
6777 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6778 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6779 will be selected only when it is active. */
6780 if (WINDOWP (window)
6781 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6782 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6783 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6784 create event iff we don't leave the
6785 selected frame. */
6786 && (focus_follows_mouse
6787 || (EQ (WVAR (XWINDOW (window), frame),
6788 WVAR (XWINDOW (selected_window), frame)))))
6789 {
6790 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6791 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6792 }
6793
6794 last_window=window;
6795 }
6796 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6797 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6798 }
6799 else
6800 {
6801 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6802 struct scroll_bar *bar
6803 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6804 event.xmotion.window);
6805
6806 if (bar)
6807 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6808 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6809
6810 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6811 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6812 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6813 }
6814
6815 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6816 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6817 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6818 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6819 do_help = 1;
6820 goto OTHER;
6821 }
6822
6823 case ConfigureNotify:
6824 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6825 #ifdef USE_GTK
6826 if (!f
6827 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6828 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6829 {
6830 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6831 event.xconfigure.height);
6832 f = 0;
6833 }
6834 #endif
6835 if (f)
6836 {
6837 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6838 #ifndef USE_GTK
6839 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6840 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6841
6842 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6843 is called by the code that handles resizing
6844 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6845
6846 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6847 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6848 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6849 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6850 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6851 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6852 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6853 {
6854 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6855 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6856 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6857 }
6858
6859 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6860 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6861 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6862 #endif
6863
6864 #ifdef USE_GTK
6865 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6866 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6867 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6868 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6869 #endif
6870 {
6871 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6872 }
6873
6874 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6875 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6876 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6877 #endif
6878
6879 }
6880 goto OTHER;
6881
6882 case ButtonRelease:
6883 case ButtonPress:
6884 {
6885 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6886 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6887 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6888
6889 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6890 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6891 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6892
6893 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6894 && last_mouse_frame
6895 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6896 f = last_mouse_frame;
6897 else
6898 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6899
6900 #ifdef USE_GTK
6901 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6902 f = 0;
6903 #endif
6904 if (f)
6905 {
6906 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6907 if (WINDOWP (FVAR (f, tool_bar_window))
6908 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (FVAR (f, tool_bar_window))))
6909 {
6910 Lisp_Object window;
6911 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6912 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6913
6914 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6915 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, FVAR (f, tool_bar_window));
6916
6917 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6918 {
6919 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6920 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6921 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6922 event.xbutton.state));
6923 }
6924 }
6925
6926 if (!tool_bar_p)
6927 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6928 if (! popup_activated ())
6929 #endif
6930 {
6931 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6932 {
6933 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6934 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6935 {
6936 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6937 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6938 }
6939 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6940 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6941 }
6942 else
6943 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6944 }
6945 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6946 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6947 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6948 }
6949 else
6950 {
6951 struct scroll_bar *bar
6952 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6953 event.xbutton.window);
6954
6955 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6956 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6957 scroll bars. */
6958 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6959 {
6960 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6961 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6962 }
6963 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6964 if (bar)
6965 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6966 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6967 }
6968
6969 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6970 {
6971 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6972 last_mouse_frame = f;
6973
6974 if (!tool_bar_p)
6975 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6976 }
6977 else
6978 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6979
6980 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6981 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6982 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6983 if (f != 0)
6984 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6985
6986 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6987 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6988 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6989 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6990 Instead, save it away
6991 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6992 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6993 if (! popup_activated ()
6994 #ifdef USE_GTK
6995 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6996 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6997 #endif
6998 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6999 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7000 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7001 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7002 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7003 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7004 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7005 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7006 {
7007 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7008 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7009 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7010 }
7011 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7012 {
7013 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7014 goto OTHER;
7015 }
7016 else
7017 goto OTHER;
7018 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7019 }
7020 break;
7021
7022 case CirculateNotify:
7023 goto OTHER;
7024
7025 case CirculateRequest:
7026 goto OTHER;
7027
7028 case VisibilityNotify:
7029 goto OTHER;
7030
7031 case MappingNotify:
7032 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7033 local cache. */
7034 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7035 {
7036 case MappingModifier:
7037 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7038 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7039 case MappingKeyboard:
7040 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7041 }
7042 goto OTHER;
7043
7044 case DestroyNotify:
7045 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7046 break;
7047
7048 default:
7049 OTHER:
7050 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7051 BLOCK_INPUT;
7052 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7053 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7054 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7055 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7056 break;
7057 }
7058
7059 done:
7060 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7061 {
7062 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7063 count++;
7064 }
7065
7066 if (do_help
7067 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7068 {
7069 Lisp_Object frame;
7070
7071 if (f)
7072 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7073 else
7074 frame = Qnil;
7075
7076 if (do_help > 0)
7077 {
7078 any_help_event_p = 1;
7079 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7080 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7081 }
7082 else
7083 {
7084 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7085 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7086 }
7087 count++;
7088 }
7089
7090 SAFE_FREE ();
7091 *eventptr = event;
7092 return count;
7093 }
7094
7095 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7096
7097 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7098 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7099 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7100
7101 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7102 int
7103 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7104 {
7105 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7106 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7107
7108 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7109
7110 if (dpyinfo)
7111 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7112
7113 return finish;
7114 }
7115 #endif
7116
7117
7118 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7119 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7120 not defined.
7121 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7122
7123 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7124 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7125 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7126 C chars).
7127
7128 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7129
7130 static int
7131 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7132 {
7133 int count = 0;
7134 int event_found = 0;
7135
7136 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7137 {
7138 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7139 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7140 pending_signals = 1;
7141 #endif
7142 return -1;
7143 }
7144
7145 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7146 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7147 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7148 #endif
7149 BLOCK_INPUT;
7150
7151 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7152 input_signal_count++;
7153
7154 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7155 ++handling_signal;
7156 #endif
7157
7158 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7159 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7160 {
7161 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7162 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7163 }
7164
7165 #ifndef USE_GTK
7166 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7167 {
7168 int finish;
7169 XEvent event;
7170
7171 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7172
7173 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7174 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7175 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7176 continue;
7177 #endif
7178 event_found = 1;
7179
7180 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7181 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7182
7183 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7184 goto out;
7185 }
7186
7187 out:;
7188
7189 #else /* USE_GTK */
7190
7191 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7192 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7193 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7194 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7195
7196 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7197 from all displays. */
7198
7199 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7200 {
7201 current_count = count;
7202 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7203
7204 gtk_main_iteration ();
7205
7206 count = current_count;
7207 current_count = -1;
7208 current_hold_quit = 0;
7209
7210 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7211 break;
7212 }
7213 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7214
7215 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7216 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7217 if (! event_found)
7218 {
7219 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7220 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7221 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7222 x_noop_count++;
7223 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7224 {
7225 x_noop_count=0;
7226
7227 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7228 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7229
7230 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7231
7232 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7233 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7234 }
7235 }
7236
7237 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7238 raise it now. */
7239 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7240 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7241 {
7242 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7243 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7244 }
7245
7246 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7247 --handling_signal;
7248 #endif
7249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7250
7251 return count;
7252 }
7253
7254
7255
7256 \f
7257 /***********************************************************************
7258 Text Cursor
7259 ***********************************************************************/
7260
7261 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7262 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7263
7264 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7265 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7266 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7267
7268 static void
7269 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7270 {
7271 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7272 XRectangle clip_rect;
7273 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7274
7275 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7276
7277 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7278 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7279 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7280 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7281 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7282
7283 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7284 }
7285
7286
7287 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7288
7289 static void
7290 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7291 {
7292 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7293 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7294 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7295 int x, y, wd, h;
7296 XGCValues xgcv;
7297 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7298 GC gc;
7299
7300 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7301 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7302 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7303 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7304 return;
7305
7306 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7307 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7308 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7309
7310 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7311 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7312 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7313 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7314 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7315 else
7316 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7317 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7318 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7319
7320 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7321 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7322 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7323 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7324 }
7325
7326
7327 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7328
7329 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7330 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7331 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7332 --gerd. */
7333
7334 static void
7335 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7336 {
7337 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WVAR (w, frame));
7338 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7339
7340 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7341 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7342 and mini-buffer. */
7343 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7344 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7345 return;
7346
7347 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7348 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7349 the bar might not be in the window. */
7350 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7351 {
7352 struct glyph_row *r;
7353 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7354 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7355 }
7356 else
7357 {
7358 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7359 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7360 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7361 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7362 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7363 XGCValues xgcv;
7364
7365 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7366 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7367 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7368 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7369 that the glyph is legible. */
7370 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7371 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7372 else
7373 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7374 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7375
7376 if (gc)
7377 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7378 else
7379 {
7380 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7381 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7382 }
7383
7384 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7385
7386 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7387 {
7388 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7389
7390 if (width < 0)
7391 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7392 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7393
7394 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7395
7396 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7397 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7398 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7399 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7400
7401 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7402 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7403 width, row->height);
7404 }
7405 else
7406 {
7407 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7408
7409 if (width < 0)
7410 width = row->height;
7411
7412 width = min (row->height, width);
7413
7414 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7415 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7416
7417 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7418 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7419 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7420 row->height - width),
7421 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7422 }
7423
7424 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7425 }
7426 }
7427
7428
7429 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7430
7431 static void
7432 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7433 {
7434 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7435 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7436 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7437 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7438 }
7439
7440
7441 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7442
7443 static void
7444 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7445 {
7446 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7447 x, y, width, height, False);
7448 #ifdef USE_GTK
7449 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7450 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7451 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7452 #endif
7453 }
7454
7455
7456 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7457
7458 static void
7459 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7460 {
7461 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7462
7463 if (on_p)
7464 {
7465 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7466 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7467
7468 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7469 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7470 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7471 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7472 {
7473 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7474 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7475 }
7476 else
7477 {
7478 switch (cursor_type)
7479 {
7480 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7481 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7482 break;
7483
7484 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7485 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7486 break;
7487
7488 case BAR_CURSOR:
7489 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7490 break;
7491
7492 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7493 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7494 break;
7495
7496 case NO_CURSOR:
7497 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7498 break;
7499
7500 default:
7501 abort ();
7502 }
7503 }
7504
7505 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7506 if (w == XWINDOW (FVAR (f, selected_window)))
7507 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7508 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7509 #endif
7510 }
7511
7512 #ifndef XFlush
7513 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7514 #endif
7515 }
7516
7517 \f
7518 /* Icons. */
7519
7520 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7521
7522 int
7523 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7524 {
7525 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7526
7527 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7528 return 1;
7529
7530 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7531 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7532 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7533 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7534
7535 if (STRINGP (file))
7536 {
7537 #ifdef USE_GTK
7538 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7539 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7540 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7541 return 0;
7542 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7543 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7544 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7545 }
7546 else
7547 {
7548 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7549 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7550 {
7551 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7552
7553 #ifdef USE_GTK
7554
7555 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7556 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7557 return 0;
7558
7559 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7560
7561 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7562 if (rc != -1)
7563 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7564
7565 #endif
7566
7567 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7568 if (rc == -1)
7569 {
7570 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7571 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7572 if (rc == -1)
7573 return 1;
7574
7575 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7576 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7577 }
7578 }
7579
7580 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7581 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7582 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7583 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7584 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7585
7586 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7587 }
7588
7589 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7590 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7591
7592 return 0;
7593 }
7594
7595
7596 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7597 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7598
7599 int
7600 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7601 {
7602 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7603 return 1;
7604
7605 {
7606 XTextProperty text;
7607 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7608 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7609 text.format = 8;
7610 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7611 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7612 }
7613
7614 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7615 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7616 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7617 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7618
7619 return 0;
7620 }
7621 \f
7622 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7623
7624 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7625 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7626
7627 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7628 be called from a signal handler.
7629 */
7630
7631 struct x_error_message_stack {
7632 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7633 Display *dpy;
7634 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7635 };
7636 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7637
7638 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7639 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7640 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7641
7642 static void
7643 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7644 {
7645 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7646 x_error_message->string,
7647 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7648 }
7649
7650 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7651 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7652 operating on.
7653
7654 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7655 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7656 stored in *x_error_message.
7657
7658 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7659 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7660
7661 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7662
7663 void
7664 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7665 {
7666 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7667
7668 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7669 XSync (dpy, False);
7670
7671 data->dpy = dpy;
7672 data->string[0] = 0;
7673 data->prev = x_error_message;
7674 x_error_message = data;
7675 }
7676
7677 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7678 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7679
7680 void
7681 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7682 {
7683 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7684
7685 BLOCK_INPUT;
7686
7687 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7688 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7689 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7690 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7691
7692 tmp = x_error_message;
7693 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7694 xfree (tmp);
7695 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7696 }
7697
7698 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7699 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7700 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7701
7702 void
7703 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7704 {
7705 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7706 XSync (dpy, False);
7707
7708 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7709 {
7710 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7711 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7712 x_uncatch_errors ();
7713 error (format, string);
7714 }
7715 }
7716
7717 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7718 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7719
7720 int
7721 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7722 {
7723 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7724 XSync (dpy, False);
7725
7726 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7727 }
7728
7729 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7730
7731 void
7732 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7733 {
7734 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7735 }
7736
7737 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7738 * idea. --lorentey */
7739 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7740
7741 void
7742 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7743 {
7744 while (x_error_message)
7745 x_uncatch_errors ();
7746 }
7747 #endif
7748
7749 #if 0
7750 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7751 x_trace_wire (void)
7752 {
7753 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7754 }
7755 #endif /* ! 0 */
7756
7757 \f
7758 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7759 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7760 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7761 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7762 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7763
7764 static void
7765 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7766 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7767 {
7768 #ifdef USG
7769 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7770 must reestablish each time */
7771 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7772 #endif /* USG */
7773 }
7774
7775 \f
7776 /************************************************************************
7777 Handling X errors
7778 ************************************************************************/
7779
7780 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7781
7782 static char *error_msg;
7783
7784 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7785 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7786
7787 static void
7788 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7789 {
7790 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7791 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7792 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7793
7794 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7795 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7796 handling_signal = 0;
7797
7798 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7799 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7800
7801 if (dpyinfo)
7802 {
7803 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7804 frame on it. */
7805 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7806 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7807 }
7808
7809 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7810 that are on the dead display. */
7811 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7812 {
7813 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7814 minibuf_frame
7815 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7816 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7817 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7818 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7819 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7820 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7824 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7825 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7826 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7827 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7828 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7829 {
7830 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7831 trying to find a replacement. */
7832 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7833 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7834 }
7835
7836 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7837 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7838 if (dpyinfo)
7839 {
7840 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7841 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7842 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7843 #ifdef USE_GTK
7844 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7845 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7846 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7847 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7848 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7849 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7850 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7851 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7852 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7853 error_msg);
7854 abort ();
7855 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7856
7857 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7858 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7859
7860 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7861 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7862 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7863 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7864 abort ();
7865
7866 {
7867 Lisp_Object tmp;
7868 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7869 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7870 }
7871 }
7872
7873 if (terminal_list == 0)
7874 {
7875 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7876 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7877 /* NOTREACHED */
7878 }
7879
7880 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7881 #ifdef SIGIO
7882 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7883 #endif
7884 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7885 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7886
7887 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7888 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7889
7890 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7891 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7892
7893 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7894 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7895 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7896 error ("%s", error_msg);
7897 }
7898
7899 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7900 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7901 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7902
7903 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7904 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7905
7906 static int
7907 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7908 {
7909 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7910 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7911 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7912 && event->minor_code == 0)
7913 {
7914 return 0;
7915 }
7916 #endif
7917
7918 if (x_error_message)
7919 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7920 else
7921 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7922 return 0;
7923 }
7924
7925 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7926 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7927 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7928
7929 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7930
7931 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7932 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7933
7934 static void NO_INLINE
7935 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7936 {
7937 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7938
7939 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7940 or colors that are not defined. */
7941
7942 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7943 return;
7944
7945 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7946 original error handler. */
7947
7948 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7949 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7950 buf, event->request_code);
7951 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7952 }
7953
7954
7955 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7956 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7957 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7958
7959 static int
7960 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7961 {
7962 char buf[256];
7963
7964 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7965 DisplayString (display));
7966 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7967 return 0;
7968 }
7969 \f
7970 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7971
7972 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7973 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7974 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7975 FONT-OBJECT. */
7976
7977 Lisp_Object
7978 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7979 {
7980 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7981
7982 if (fontset < 0)
7983 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7984 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7985 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7986 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7987 do. */
7988 return font_object;
7989
7990 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7991 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7992 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7993 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7994 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7995
7996 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7997
7998 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7999 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8000 {
8001 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8002 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8003 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8004 }
8005 else
8006 {
8007 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8008 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8009 }
8010
8011 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8012 {
8013 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8014 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8015 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8016 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8017 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8018 }
8019
8020 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8021 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8022 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8023 {
8024 BLOCK_INPUT;
8025 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8027 }
8028 #endif
8029
8030 return font_object;
8031 }
8032
8033 \f
8034 /***********************************************************************
8035 X Input Methods
8036 ***********************************************************************/
8037
8038 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8039
8040 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8041
8042 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8043 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8044 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8045
8046 static void
8047 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8048 {
8049 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8050 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8051
8052 BLOCK_INPUT;
8053
8054 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8055 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8056 {
8057 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8058 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8059 {
8060 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8061 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8062 }
8063 }
8064
8065 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8066 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8067 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8068 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8069 }
8070
8071 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8072
8073 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8074 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8075 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8076 #endif
8077
8078 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8079 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8080
8081 static void
8082 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8083 {
8084 XIM xim;
8085
8086 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8087 if (use_xim)
8088 {
8089 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8090 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8091 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8092 emacs_class);
8093 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8094
8095 if (xim)
8096 {
8097 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8098 XIMCallback destroy;
8099 #endif
8100
8101 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8102 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8103
8104 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8105 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8106 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8107 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8108 #endif
8109 }
8110 }
8111
8112 else
8113 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8114 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8115 }
8116
8117
8118 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8119
8120 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8121 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8122 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8123 when the callback was registered. */
8124
8125 static void
8126 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8127 {
8128 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8129 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8130
8131 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8132 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8133 return;
8134
8135 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8136
8137 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8138 as they have no XIC. */
8139 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8140 {
8141 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8142
8143 BLOCK_INPUT;
8144 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8145 {
8146 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8147
8148 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8149 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8150 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8151 {
8152 create_frame_xic (f);
8153 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8154 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8155 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8156 {
8157 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FVAR (f, selected_window));
8158 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8159 }
8160 }
8161 }
8162
8163 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8164 }
8165 }
8166
8167 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8168
8169
8170 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8171 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8172 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8173 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8174
8175 static void
8176 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8177 {
8178 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8179 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8180 if (use_xim)
8181 {
8182 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8183 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8184 ptrdiff_t len;
8185
8186 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8187 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8188 len = strlen (resource_name);
8189 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8190 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8191 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8192 resource_name, emacs_class,
8193 xim_instantiate_callback,
8194 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8195 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8196 least, hence the configure test. */
8197 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8198 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8199 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8200 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8201 }
8202 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8203 }
8204
8205
8206 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8207
8208 static void
8209 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8210 {
8211 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8212 if (use_xim)
8213 {
8214 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8215 if (dpyinfo->display)
8216 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8217 NULL, emacs_class,
8218 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8219 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8220 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8221 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8222 if (dpyinfo->display)
8223 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8224 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8225 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8226 }
8227 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8228 }
8229
8230 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8231
8232
8233 \f
8234 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8235 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8236
8237 static void
8238 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8239 {
8240 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8241
8242 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8243 is already for the top-left corner. */
8244 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8245 return;
8246
8247 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8248 position that fits on the screen. */
8249 if (flags & XNegative)
8250 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8251 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8252
8253 {
8254 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8255
8256 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8257 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8258 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8259
8260 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8261 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8262 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8263 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8264 is right, though.
8265
8266 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8267 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8268
8269 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8270 #endif
8271
8272 if (flags & YNegative)
8273 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8274 - height + f->top_pos;
8275 }
8276
8277 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8278 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8279 so the flags should correspond. */
8280 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8281 }
8282
8283 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8284 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8285 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8286 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8287 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8288
8289 void
8290 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8291 {
8292 int modified_top, modified_left;
8293
8294 if (change_gravity > 0)
8295 {
8296 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8297 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8298
8299 f->top_pos = yoff;
8300 f->left_pos = xoff;
8301 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8302 if (xoff < 0)
8303 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8304 if (yoff < 0)
8305 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8306 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8307 }
8308 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8309
8310 BLOCK_INPUT;
8311 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8312
8313 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8314 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8315
8316 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8317 {
8318 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8319 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8320 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8321 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8322 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8323 }
8324
8325 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8326 modified_left, modified_top);
8327
8328 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8329 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8330 ? 1 : 0);
8331
8332 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8333 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8334 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8335 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8336 of the frame.
8337
8338 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8339 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8340 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8341
8342 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8343 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8344 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8345 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8346 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8347 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8348
8349 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8350 }
8351
8352 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8353 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8354 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8355 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8356 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8357
8358 static int
8359 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8360 {
8361 Atom actual_type;
8362 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8363 int i, rc, actual_format;
8364 Window wmcheck_window;
8365 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8366 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8367 long max_len = 65536;
8368 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8369 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8370 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8371
8372 BLOCK_INPUT;
8373
8374 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8375 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8376 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8377 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8378 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8379 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8380
8381 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8382 {
8383 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8384 x_uncatch_errors ();
8385 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8386 return 0;
8387 }
8388
8389 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8390 XFree (tmp_data);
8391
8392 /* Check if window exists. */
8393 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8394 x_sync (f);
8395 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8396 {
8397 x_uncatch_errors ();
8398 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8399 return 0;
8400 }
8401
8402 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8403 {
8404 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8405 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8406 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8407 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8408 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8409 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8410
8411 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8412 tmp_data = NULL;
8413 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8414 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8415 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8416 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8417 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8418
8419 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8420 {
8421 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8422 x_uncatch_errors ();
8423 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8424 return 0;
8425 }
8426
8427 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8428 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8429 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8430 }
8431
8432 rc = 0;
8433
8434 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8435 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8436
8437 x_uncatch_errors ();
8438 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8439
8440 return rc;
8441 }
8442
8443 static void
8444 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8445 {
8446 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8447
8448 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8449 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8450 make_number (32),
8451 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8452 Fcons
8453 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8454 Fcons
8455 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8456 value != 0
8457 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8458 : Qnil)));
8459 }
8460
8461 void
8462 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8463 {
8464 Lisp_Object frame;
8465 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8466
8467 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8468
8469 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8470 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8471 }
8472
8473 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8474 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8475 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8476
8477 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8478
8479 static int
8480 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8481 Window window,
8482 int *size_state,
8483 int *sticky)
8484 {
8485 Atom actual_type;
8486 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8487 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8488 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8489 long max_len = 65536;
8490 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8491 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8492 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8493
8494 *sticky = 0;
8495 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8496
8497 BLOCK_INPUT;
8498 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8499 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8500 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8501 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8502 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8503
8504 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8505 {
8506 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8507 x_uncatch_errors ();
8508 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8509 return ! f->iconified;
8510 }
8511
8512 x_uncatch_errors ();
8513
8514 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8515 {
8516 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8517 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8518 {
8519 is_hidden = 1;
8520 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8521 }
8522 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8523 {
8524 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8525 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8526 else
8527 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8528 }
8529 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8530 {
8531 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8532 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8533 else
8534 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8535 }
8536 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8537 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8538 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8539 *sticky = 1;
8540 }
8541
8542 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8543 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8544 return ! is_hidden;
8545 }
8546
8547 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8548
8549 static int
8550 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8551 {
8552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8553 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8554 int cur, dummy;
8555
8556 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8557
8558 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8559 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8560 if (!have_net_atom)
8561 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8562
8563 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8564 {
8565 Lisp_Object frame;
8566
8567 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8568
8569 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8570 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8571 are sent at once. */
8572 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8573 {
8574 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8575 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8576 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8577 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8578 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8579 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8580 break;
8581 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8582 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8583 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8584 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8585 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8586 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8587 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8588 break;
8589 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8590 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8591 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8592 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8593 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8594 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8595 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8596 break;
8597 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8598 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8599 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8600 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8601 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8602 break;
8603 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8604 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8605 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8606 else
8607 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8608 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8609 }
8610
8611 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8612
8613 }
8614
8615 return have_net_atom;
8616 }
8617
8618 static void
8619 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8620 {
8621 if (f->async_visible)
8622 {
8623 BLOCK_INPUT;
8624 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8625 x_sync (f);
8626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8627 }
8628 }
8629
8630
8631 static int
8632 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8633 {
8634 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8635 Lisp_Object lval;
8636 int sticky = 0;
8637 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8638
8639 lval = Qnil;
8640 switch (value)
8641 {
8642 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8643 lval = Qfullwidth;
8644 break;
8645 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8646 lval = Qfullheight;
8647 break;
8648 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8649 lval = Qfullboth;
8650 break;
8651 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8652 lval = Qmaximized;
8653 break;
8654 }
8655
8656 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8657 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8658
8659 return not_hidden;
8660 }
8661
8662 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8663 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8664 static void
8665 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8666 {
8667 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8668 return;
8669
8670 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8671 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8672
8673 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8674 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8675 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8676
8677 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8678 {
8679 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8680 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8681
8682 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8683 {
8684 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8685 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8686 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8687 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8688 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8689 break;
8690 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8691 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8692 break;
8693 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8694 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8695 }
8696
8697 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8698 width, height);
8699 }
8700 }
8701
8702 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8703 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8704 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8705 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8706 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8707 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8708 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8709
8710 static void
8711 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8712 {
8713 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8714
8715 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8716 window manager window around the frame. */
8717
8718 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8719
8720 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8721 {
8722 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8723
8724 int adjusted_left;
8725 int adjusted_top;
8726
8727 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8728 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8729 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8730
8731 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8732
8733 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8734 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8735
8736 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8737 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8738
8739 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8740 }
8741 else
8742 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8743 frame's position. */
8744
8745 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8746 }
8747
8748
8749 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8750 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8751 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8752 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8753 of an exact comparison. */
8754
8755 static void
8756 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8757 {
8758 int count = 0;
8759
8760 while (count++ < 50)
8761 {
8762 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8763
8764 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8765 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8766 loop. */
8767
8768 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8769 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8770
8771 if (fuzzy)
8772 {
8773 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8774 pixels. */
8775
8776 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8777 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8778 return;
8779 }
8780 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8781 return;
8782 }
8783
8784 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8785 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8786
8787 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8788 }
8789
8790
8791 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8792 void
8793 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8794 {
8795 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8796
8797 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8798 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8799 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8800
8801 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8802 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8803
8804 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8805 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8806 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8807 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8808
8809 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8810 {
8811 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8812 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8813 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8814 BLOCK_INPUT;
8815 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8816
8817 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8818 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8819
8820 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8821 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8822 break;
8823
8824 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8825 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8826 break; /* Timeout */
8827 }
8828 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8829 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8830 }
8831
8832
8833 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8834 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8835 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8836 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8837
8838 static void
8839 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8840 {
8841 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8842
8843 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8844 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8845 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8846 ? 0
8847 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8848
8849 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8850
8851 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8852 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8853 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8854 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8855
8856 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8857 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8858 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8859 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8860
8861
8862 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8863 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8864 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8865 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8866 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8867
8868 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8869 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8870 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8871 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8872
8873 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8874 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8875 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8876 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8877 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8878
8879 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8880 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8881
8882 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8883 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8884 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8885 if (f->async_visible)
8886 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8887 else
8888 {
8889 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8890 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8891 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8892 x_sync (f);
8893 }
8894 }
8895
8896
8897 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8898 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8899 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8900 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8901
8902 void
8903 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8904 {
8905 BLOCK_INPUT;
8906
8907 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8908 {
8909 int r, c;
8910
8911 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8912 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8913 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8914 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8915 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8916 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8917 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8918 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8919 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8920 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8921 is however. */
8922 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8923 #endif
8924 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8925 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8926 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8927 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8928 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8929 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8930 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8931 }
8932
8933 #ifdef USE_GTK
8934 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8935 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8936 else
8937 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8938 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8939
8940 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8941
8942 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8943
8944 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8945 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FVAR (f, root_window)));
8946
8947 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8948 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8949 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8950 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8951 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8952
8953 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8954 }
8955 \f
8956 /* Mouse warping. */
8957
8958 void
8959 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8960 {
8961 int pix_x, pix_y;
8962
8963 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8964 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8965
8966 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8967 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8968
8969 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8970 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8971
8972 BLOCK_INPUT;
8973
8974 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8975 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8976 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8977 }
8978
8979 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8980
8981 void
8982 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8983 {
8984 BLOCK_INPUT;
8985
8986 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8987 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8988 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8989 }
8990 \f
8991 /* Raise frame F. */
8992
8993 void
8994 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8995 {
8996 BLOCK_INPUT;
8997 if (f->async_visible)
8998 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8999
9000 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9002 }
9003
9004 /* Lower frame F. */
9005
9006 static void
9007 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9008 {
9009 if (f->async_visible)
9010 {
9011 BLOCK_INPUT;
9012 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9013 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9014 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9015 }
9016 }
9017
9018 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9019
9020 void
9021 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9022 {
9023 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9024 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9025 if (f->async_visible)
9026 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9027 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9028 }
9029
9030 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9031
9032 void
9033 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9034 {
9035 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9036 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9037
9038 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9039 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9040 {
9041 Lisp_Object frame;
9042 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9043 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9044 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9045 make_number (32),
9046 Fcons (make_number (1),
9047 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9048 Qnil)));
9049 }
9050 }
9051
9052 static void
9053 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9054 {
9055 if (raise_flag)
9056 x_raise_frame (f);
9057 else
9058 x_lower_frame (f);
9059 }
9060 \f
9061 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9062
9063 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9064
9065 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9066
9067 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9068
9069 static void
9070 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9071 {
9072 unsigned long data[2];
9073 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9074
9075 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9076 data[1] = flags;
9077
9078 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9079 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9080 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9081 }
9082 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9083
9084 static void
9085 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9086 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9087 {
9088 XEvent event;
9089
9090 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9091 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9092 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9093 event.xclient.format = 32;
9094 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9095 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9096 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9097 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9098 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9099
9100 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9101 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9102 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9103 }
9104 \f
9105 /* Change of visibility. */
9106
9107 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9108 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9109 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9110 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9111 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9112 finishes with it. */
9113
9114 void
9115 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9116 {
9117 Lisp_Object type;
9118 int original_top, original_left;
9119 int retry_count = 2;
9120
9121 retry:
9122
9123 BLOCK_INPUT;
9124
9125 type = x_icon_type (f);
9126 if (!NILP (type))
9127 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9128
9129 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9130 {
9131 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9132 call x_set_offset a second time
9133 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9134 before the window gets really visible. */
9135 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9136 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9137 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9138 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9139
9140 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9141
9142 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9143 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9144 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9145 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9146 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9147 else
9148 {
9149 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9150 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9151 }
9152 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9153 #ifdef USE_GTK
9154 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9155 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9156 #else
9157 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9158 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9159 else
9160 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9161 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9162 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9163 }
9164
9165 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9166
9167 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9168 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9169 so that incoming events are handled. */
9170 {
9171 Lisp_Object frame;
9172 int count;
9173 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9174 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9175 will set it when they are handled. */
9176 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9177
9178 original_left = f->left_pos;
9179 original_top = f->top_pos;
9180
9181 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9183
9184 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9185
9186 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9187 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9188 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9189 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9190
9191 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9192 because the window manager may choose the position
9193 and we don't want to override it. */
9194
9195 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9196 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9197 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9198 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9199 && previously_visible)
9200 {
9201 Drawable rootw;
9202 int x, y;
9203 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9204
9205 BLOCK_INPUT;
9206
9207 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9208 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9209 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9210 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9211 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9212 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9213 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9214 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9215 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9216
9217 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9218 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9219 original_left, original_top);
9220
9221 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9222 }
9223
9224 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9225
9226 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9227 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9228 MapNotify at all.. */
9229 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9230 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9231 {
9232 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9233 x_sync (f);
9234
9235 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9236 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9237 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9238 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9239 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9240 probably a bug. */
9241 if (input_polling_used ())
9242 {
9243 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9244 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9245 handler reset it. */
9246 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9247 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9248 poll_for_input_1 ();
9249 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9250 }
9251
9252 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9253 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9254 }
9255
9256 /* 2000-09-28: In
9257
9258 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9259 (iconify-frame f)
9260 (raise-frame f))
9261
9262 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9263 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9264 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9265 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9266
9267 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9268 goto retry;
9269 }
9270 }
9271
9272 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9273
9274 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9275
9276 void
9277 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9278 {
9279 Window window;
9280
9281 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9282 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9283
9284 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9285 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9286 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9287
9288 BLOCK_INPUT;
9289
9290 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9291 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9292 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9293 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9294 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9295 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9296
9297 #ifdef USE_GTK
9298 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9299 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9300 else
9301 #else
9302 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9303 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9304 else
9305 #endif
9306 {
9307
9308 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9309 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9310 {
9311 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9312 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9313 }
9314 }
9315
9316 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9317 just by the event that we get from the server.
9318 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9319 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9320 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9321 f->visible = 0;
9322 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9323 f->async_visible = 0;
9324 f->async_iconified = 0;
9325
9326 x_sync (f);
9327
9328 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9329 }
9330
9331 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9332
9333 void
9334 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9335 {
9336 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9337 int result;
9338 #endif
9339 Lisp_Object type;
9340
9341 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9342 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9343 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9344
9345 if (f->async_iconified)
9346 return;
9347
9348 BLOCK_INPUT;
9349
9350 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9351
9352 type = x_icon_type (f);
9353 if (!NILP (type))
9354 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9355
9356 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9357 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9358 {
9359 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9360 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9361
9362 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9363 f->iconified = 1;
9364 f->visible = 1;
9365 f->async_iconified = 1;
9366 f->async_visible = 0;
9367 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9368 return;
9369 }
9370 #endif
9371
9372 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9373
9374 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9375 {
9376 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9377 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9378 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9379 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9380 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9381 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9382 so we have to record it here. */
9383 f->iconified = 1;
9384 f->visible = 1;
9385 f->async_iconified = 1;
9386 f->async_visible = 0;
9387 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9388 return;
9389 }
9390
9391 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9392 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9393 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9394 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9395
9396 if (!result)
9397 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9398
9399 f->async_iconified = 1;
9400 f->async_visible = 0;
9401
9402
9403 BLOCK_INPUT;
9404 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9405 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9406 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9407
9408 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9409 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9410 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9411 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9412 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9413 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9414
9415 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9416 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9417
9418 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9419 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9420 {
9421 XEvent msg;
9422
9423 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9424 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9425 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9426 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9427 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9428
9429 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9430 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9431 False,
9432 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9433 &msg))
9434 {
9435 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9436 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9437 }
9438 }
9439
9440 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9441 IconicState. */
9442 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9443
9444 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9445 {
9446 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9447 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9448 }
9449
9450 f->async_iconified = 1;
9451 f->async_visible = 0;
9452
9453 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9454 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9455 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9456 }
9457
9458 \f
9459 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9460
9461 void
9462 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9463 {
9464 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9465 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9466 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9467 Lisp_Object bar;
9468 struct scroll_bar *b;
9469 #endif
9470
9471 BLOCK_INPUT;
9472
9473 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9474 commands to the X server. */
9475 if (dpyinfo->display)
9476 {
9477 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9478 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9479 face. */
9480 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9481 free_frame_faces (f);
9482
9483 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9484 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9485
9486 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9487 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9488 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9489 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9490 toolkit scroll bars. */
9491 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9492 {
9493 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9494 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9495 }
9496 #endif
9497
9498 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9499 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9500 free_frame_xic (f);
9501 #endif
9502
9503 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9504 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9505 {
9506 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9507 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9508 }
9509 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9510 we are using a toolkit. */
9511 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9512 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9513
9514 free_frame_menubar (f);
9515 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9516
9517 #ifdef USE_GTK
9518 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9519 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9520
9521 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9522 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9523 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9524
9525 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9526 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9527 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9528 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9529 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9530 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9531
9532 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9533 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9534 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9535 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9536 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9537 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9538 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9539 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9540 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9541 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9542 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9543 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9544 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9545 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9546 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9547
9548 x_free_gcs (f);
9549 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9550 }
9551
9552 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9553 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9554 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9555
9556 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9557 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9558 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9559 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9560 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9561 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9562
9563 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9564 {
9565 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9566 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9567 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9568 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9569 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9570 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9571 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9572 }
9573
9574 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9575 }
9576
9577
9578 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9579
9580 static void
9581 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9582 {
9583 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9584
9585 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9586 commands to the X server. */
9587 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9588 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9589
9590 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9591 }
9592
9593 \f
9594 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9595
9596 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9597 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9598 that the window now has.
9599 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9600 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9601 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9602
9603 #ifndef USE_GTK
9604 void
9605 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9606 {
9607 XSizeHints size_hints;
9608 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9609
9610 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9611 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9612 {
9613 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9614 return;
9615 }
9616 #endif
9617
9618 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9619 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9620
9621 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9622 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9623
9624 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9625 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9626
9627 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9628 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9629 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9630 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9631 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9632 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9633
9634 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9635 {
9636 int base_width, base_height;
9637 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9638
9639 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9640 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9641
9642 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9643
9644 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9645 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9646 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9647 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9648 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9649
9650 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9651 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9652 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9653
9654 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9655 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9656 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9657 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9658 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9659 }
9660
9661 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9662 if (flags)
9663 {
9664 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9665 goto no_read;
9666 }
9667
9668 {
9669 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9670 long supplied_return;
9671 int value;
9672
9673 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9674 &supplied_return);
9675
9676 if (flags)
9677 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9678 else
9679 {
9680 if (value == 0)
9681 hints.flags = 0;
9682 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9683 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9684 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9685 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9686 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9687 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9688 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9689 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9690 }
9691 }
9692
9693 no_read:
9694
9695 #ifdef PWinGravity
9696 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9697 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9698
9699 if (user_position)
9700 {
9701 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9702 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9703 }
9704 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9705
9706 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9707 }
9708 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9709
9710 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9711
9712 static void
9713 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9714 {
9715 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9716 Arg al[1];
9717
9718 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9719 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9720 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9721 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9722
9723 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9724 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9725
9726 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9727 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9728 }
9729
9730 static void
9731 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9732 {
9733 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9734
9735 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9736 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9737 #endif
9738
9739 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9740 {
9741 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9742 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9743 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9744 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9745 }
9746 else
9747 {
9748 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9749 pixmap. */
9750 return;
9751 }
9752
9753
9754 #ifdef USE_GTK
9755 {
9756 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9757 return;
9758 }
9759
9760 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9761
9762 {
9763 Arg al[1];
9764 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9765 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9766 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9767 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9768 }
9769
9770 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9771
9772 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9773 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9774
9775 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9776 }
9777
9778 void
9779 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9780 {
9781 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9782
9783 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9784 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9785 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9786
9787 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9788 }
9789
9790 \f
9791 /***********************************************************************
9792 Fonts
9793 ***********************************************************************/
9794
9795 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9796
9797 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9798 font table. */
9799
9800 static void
9801 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9802 {
9803 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9804 if (font->driver->check)
9805 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9806 }
9807
9808 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9809
9810 \f
9811 /***********************************************************************
9812 Initialization
9813 ***********************************************************************/
9814
9815 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9816 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9817 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9818 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9819
9820 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9821 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9822 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9823
9824 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9825 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9826 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9827 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9828 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9829 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9830 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9831 };
9832
9833 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9834
9835 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9836
9837 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9838
9839 static int x_initialized;
9840
9841 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9842 the screen number from the server number. */
9843 static int
9844 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9845 {
9846 int seen_colon = 0;
9847 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9848 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9849 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9850
9851 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9852 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9853 length_until_period++;
9854
9855 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9856 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9857 name1 += 4;
9858 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9859 name2 += 4;
9860 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9861 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9862 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9863 name1 += system_name_length;
9864 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9865 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9866 name2 += system_name_length;
9867 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9868 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9869 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9870 name1 += length_until_period;
9871 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9872 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9873 name2 += length_until_period;
9874
9875 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9876 {
9877 if (*name1 == ':')
9878 seen_colon = 1;
9879 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9880 return 1;
9881 }
9882 return (seen_colon
9883 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9884 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9885 }
9886
9887 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9888 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9889 to 5. */
9890 static void
9891 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9892 {
9893 int nr = 0;
9894 int off = 0;
9895
9896 while (!(mask & 1))
9897 {
9898 off++;
9899 mask >>= 1;
9900 }
9901
9902 while (mask & 1)
9903 {
9904 nr++;
9905 mask >>= 1;
9906 }
9907
9908 *offset = off;
9909 *bits = nr;
9910 }
9911
9912 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9913 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9914
9915 int
9916 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9917 {
9918 int dpy_ok = 1;
9919 Display *dpy;
9920
9921 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9922 if (dpy)
9923 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9924 else
9925 dpy_ok = 0;
9926 return dpy_ok;
9927 }
9928
9929 #ifdef USE_GTK
9930 static void
9931 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9932 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9933 {
9934 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9935 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9936 }
9937 #endif
9938
9939 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9940 the structure that describes the open display.
9941 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9942
9943 struct x_display_info *
9944 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9945 {
9946 int connection;
9947 Display *dpy;
9948 struct terminal *terminal;
9949 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9950 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9951 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9952 ptrdiff_t lim;
9953
9954 BLOCK_INPUT;
9955
9956 if (!x_initialized)
9957 {
9958 x_initialize ();
9959 ++x_initialized;
9960 }
9961
9962 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9963 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9964
9965 #ifdef USE_GTK
9966 {
9967 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9968 int argc;
9969 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9970 char **argv2 = argv;
9971 guint id;
9972
9973 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9974 {
9975 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9976 }
9977 else
9978 {
9979 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9980 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9981
9982 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9983 argv[argc] = 0;
9984
9985 argc = 0;
9986 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9987
9988 if (! NILP (display_name))
9989 {
9990 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9991 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9992 }
9993
9994 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9995 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9996
9997 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9998
9999 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10000 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10001 {
10002 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
10003 putenv (fix_events);
10004 }
10005
10006 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10007 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10008 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10009 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10010
10011 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10012 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10013 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10014
10015 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10016 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10017
10018 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10019 fixup_locale ();
10020 xg_initialize ();
10021
10022 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10023
10024 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10025 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10026 {
10027 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10028 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10029
10030 s = build_string (file);
10031 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10032
10033 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10034 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10035 }
10036 #endif
10037
10038 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10039 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10040 }
10041 }
10042 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10043 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10044 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10045 errors with X11R5:
10046 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10047 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10048 So let's not use it until R6. */
10049 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10050 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10051 #endif
10052
10053 {
10054 int argc = 0;
10055 char *argv[3];
10056
10057 argv[0] = "";
10058 argc = 1;
10059 if (xrm_option)
10060 {
10061 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10062 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10063 }
10064 turn_on_atimers (0);
10065 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10066 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10067 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10068 &argc, argv);
10069 turn_on_atimers (1);
10070
10071 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10072 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10073 fixup_locale ();
10074 #endif
10075 }
10076
10077 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10078 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10079 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10080 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10081 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10082
10083 /* Detect failure. */
10084 if (dpy == 0)
10085 {
10086 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10087 return 0;
10088 }
10089
10090 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10091
10092 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10093 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10094
10095 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10096
10097 {
10098 struct x_display_info *share;
10099 Lisp_Object tail;
10100
10101 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10102 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10103 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10104 SSDATA (display_name)))
10105 break;
10106 if (share)
10107 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10108 else
10109 {
10110 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10111 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10112 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10113
10114 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10115 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10116 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10117 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10118 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10119
10120 if (!EQ (SVAR (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms), function), Qunbound))
10121 {
10122 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10123
10124 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10125 list of terminals. */
10126 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10127 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10128 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10129 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10130
10131 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10132 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10134 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10135 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10136 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10137 BLOCK_INPUT;
10138 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10139 terminal_list = terminal;
10140 UNGCPRO;
10141 }
10142
10143 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10144 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10145 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10146 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10147 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10148 }
10149 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10150 }
10151
10152 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10153 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10154 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10155
10156 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10157 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10158 x_display_name_list);
10159 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10160
10161 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10162
10163 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10164 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10165 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10166 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10167
10168 #if 0
10169 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10170 #endif /* ! 0 */
10171
10172 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10173 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10174 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10175 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10176 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10177 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10178 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10179
10180 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10181 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10182
10183 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10184 #ifdef USE_GTK
10185 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10186 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10187 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10188
10189 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10190 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10191
10192 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10193 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10194 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10195 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10196 #else
10197 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10198 #endif
10199 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10200 all versions. */
10201 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10202
10203 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10204 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10205 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10206 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10207 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10208 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10209 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10210 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10211 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10212 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10213 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10214 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10215 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10216 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10217 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10218 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10219 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10220 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10221 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10222 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10223 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10224 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10225 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10226 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10227 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10228 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10229 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10230 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10231
10232 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10233 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10234 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10235
10236 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10237 {
10238 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10239 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10240 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10241 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10242 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10243 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10244 }
10245
10246 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10247 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10248 {
10249 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10250 {
10251 Lisp_Object value;
10252 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10253 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10254 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10255 Qnil, Qnil);
10256 if (STRINGP (value)
10257 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10258 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10259 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10260 }
10261 }
10262 else
10263 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10264 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10265
10266 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10267 {
10268 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10269 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10270 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10271 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10272 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10273 for example). */
10274 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10275 double d;
10276 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10277 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10278 }
10279 #endif
10280
10281 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10282 {
10283 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10284 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10285 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10286 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10287 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10288 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10289 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10290 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10291 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10292 }
10293
10294 {
10295 const struct
10296 {
10297 const char *name;
10298 Atom *atom;
10299 } atom_refs[] = {
10300 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10301 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10302 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10303 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10304 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10305 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10306 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10307 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10308 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10309 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10310 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10311 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10312 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10313 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10314 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10315 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10316 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10317 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10318 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10319 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10320 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10321 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10322 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10323 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10324 /* For properties of font. */
10325 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10326 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10327 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10328 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10329 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10330 /* Ghostscript support. */
10331 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10332 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10333 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10334 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10335 /* EWMH */
10336 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10337 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10338 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10339 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10340 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10341 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10342 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10343 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10344 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10345 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10346 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10347 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10348 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10349 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10350 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10351 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10352 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10353 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10354 /* Session management */
10355 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10356 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10357 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10358 };
10359
10360 int i;
10361 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10362 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10363 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10364 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10365 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10366 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10367 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10368 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10369
10370 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10371 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10372
10373 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10374 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10375 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10376 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10377
10378 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10379 False, atoms_return);
10380
10381 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10382 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10383
10384 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10385 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10386
10387 xfree (atom_names);
10388 xfree (atoms_return);
10389 }
10390
10391 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10392 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10393 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10394 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10395
10396 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10397 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10398 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10399
10400 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10401 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10402 dpyinfo->gray
10403 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10404 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10405 1, 0, 1);
10406
10407 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10408 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10409 #endif
10410
10411 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10412
10413 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10414 if (connection != 0)
10415 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10416
10417 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10418 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10419 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10420
10421 #ifdef SIGIO
10422 if (interrupt_input)
10423 init_sigio (connection);
10424 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10425
10426 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10427 {
10428 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10429 Font font;
10430
10431 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10432 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10433 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10434 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10435 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10436 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10437 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10438 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10439 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10440 abort ();
10441 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10442 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10443 x_uncatch_errors ();
10444 }
10445 #endif
10446
10447 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10448 for debugging X code. */
10449 {
10450 Lisp_Object value;
10451 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10452 build_string ("synchronous"),
10453 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10454 Qnil, Qnil);
10455 if (STRINGP (value)
10456 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10457 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10458 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10459 }
10460
10461 {
10462 Lisp_Object value;
10463 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10464 build_string ("useXIM"),
10465 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10466 Qnil, Qnil);
10467 #ifdef USE_XIM
10468 if (STRINGP (value)
10469 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10470 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10471 use_xim = 0;
10472 #else
10473 if (STRINGP (value)
10474 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10475 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10476 use_xim = 1;
10477 #endif
10478 }
10479
10480 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10481 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10482 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10483 tty. */
10484 if (terminal->id == 1)
10485 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10486 #endif
10487
10488 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10489
10490 return dpyinfo;
10491 }
10492 \f
10493 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10494 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10495
10496 static void
10497 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10498 {
10499 struct terminal *t;
10500
10501 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10502 X display. */
10503 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10504 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10505 {
10506 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10507 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10508 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10509 x_session_close ();
10510 #endif
10511 delete_terminal (t);
10512 break;
10513 }
10514
10515 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10516
10517 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10518 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10519 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10520 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10521 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10522 else
10523 {
10524 Lisp_Object tail;
10525
10526 tail = x_display_name_list;
10527 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10528 {
10529 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10530 {
10531 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10532 break;
10533 }
10534 tail = XCDR (tail);
10535 }
10536 }
10537
10538 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10539 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10540
10541 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10542 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10543 else
10544 {
10545 struct x_display_info *tail;
10546
10547 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10548 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10549 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10550 }
10551
10552 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10553 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10554 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10555 xfree (dpyinfo);
10556 }
10557
10558 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10559
10560 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10561 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10562 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10563 that slows us down. */
10564
10565 static void
10566 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10567 {
10568 BLOCK_INPUT;
10569 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10570 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10571 {
10572 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10573 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10574 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10575 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10576 }
10577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10578 }
10579
10580 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10581 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10582 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10583 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10584 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10585 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10586 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10587
10588 void
10589 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10590 {
10591 BLOCK_INPUT;
10592 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10593 {
10594 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10595 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10596 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10597 }
10598 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10599 }
10600
10601 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10602
10603 \f
10604 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10605
10606 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10607
10608 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10609 {
10610 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10611 x_produce_glyphs,
10612 x_write_glyphs,
10613 x_insert_glyphs,
10614 x_clear_end_of_line,
10615 x_scroll_run,
10616 x_after_update_window_line,
10617 x_update_window_begin,
10618 x_update_window_end,
10619 x_cursor_to,
10620 x_flush,
10621 #ifdef XFlush
10622 x_flush,
10623 #else
10624 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10625 #endif
10626 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10627 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10628 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10629 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10630 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10631 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10632 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10633 x_draw_glyph_string,
10634 x_define_frame_cursor,
10635 x_clear_frame_area,
10636 x_draw_window_cursor,
10637 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10638 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10639 };
10640
10641
10642 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10643 void
10644 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10645 {
10646 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10647
10648 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10649 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10650 if (!terminal->name)
10651 return;
10652
10653 BLOCK_INPUT;
10654 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10655 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10656 X display. */
10657 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10658 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10659 #endif
10660
10661 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10662 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10663 if (dpyinfo->display)
10664 {
10665 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10666 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10667
10668 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10669 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10670 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10671 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10672
10673 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10674 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10675 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10676 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10677 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10678 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10679 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10680 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10681 leaks in other situations. */
10682 #if 0
10683 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10684 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10685 #else
10686 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10687 #endif
10688 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10689 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10690 closing all the displays. */
10691 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10692 #endif
10693
10694 #ifdef USE_GTK
10695 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10696 #else
10697 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10698 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10699 #else
10700 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10701 #endif
10702 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10703 }
10704
10705 /* Mark as dead. */
10706 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10707 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10708 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10709 }
10710
10711 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10712 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10713
10714 static struct terminal *
10715 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10716 {
10717 struct terminal *terminal;
10718
10719 terminal = create_terminal ();
10720
10721 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10722 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10723 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10724
10725 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10726
10727 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10728 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10729 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10730 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10731 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10732 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10733 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10734 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10735 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10736 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10737 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10738 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10739 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10740 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10741 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10742 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10743 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10744 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10745 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10746 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10747
10748 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10749 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10750
10751 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10752 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10753 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10754 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10755 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10756 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10757 off the bottom. */
10758
10759 return terminal;
10760 }
10761
10762 void
10763 x_initialize (void)
10764 {
10765 baud_rate = 19200;
10766
10767 x_noop_count = 0;
10768 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10769 any_help_event_p = 0;
10770 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10771
10772 #ifdef USE_GTK
10773 current_count = -1;
10774 #endif
10775
10776 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10777 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10778
10779 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10780 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10781
10782 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10783
10784 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10785 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10786 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10787 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10788 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10789 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10790 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10791
10792 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10793 #endif
10794
10795 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10796 #ifndef USE_GTK
10797 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10798 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10799 #endif
10800 #endif
10801
10802 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10803 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10804 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10805
10806 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10807 original error handler. */
10808 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10809 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10810
10811 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10812
10813 xgselect_initialize ();
10814 }
10815
10816
10817 void
10818 syms_of_xterm (void)
10819 {
10820 x_error_message = NULL;
10821
10822 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10823 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10824
10825 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10826 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10827
10828 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10829 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10830
10831 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10832 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10833
10834 #ifdef USE_GTK
10835 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10836 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10837
10838 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10839 #endif
10840
10841 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10842 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10843 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10844 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10845 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10846 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10847 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10848 sizes. */);
10849 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10850
10851 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10852 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10853 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10854 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10855 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10856 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10857 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10858
10859 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10860 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10861 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10862 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10863 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10864 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10865 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10866 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10867 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10868
10869 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10870 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10871 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10872 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10873 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10874 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10875 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10876 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10877 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10878 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10879 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10880 #elif USE_GTK
10881 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10882 #else
10883 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10884 #endif
10885 #else
10886 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10887 #endif
10888
10889 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10890 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10891
10892 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10893 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10894 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10895 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10896 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10897 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10898 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10899 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10900 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10901
10902 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10903 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10904 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10905 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10906 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10907 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10908
10909 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10910 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10911 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10912 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10913 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10914 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10915
10916 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10917 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10918 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10919 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10920 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10921 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10922
10923 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10924 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10925 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10926 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10927 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10928 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10929
10930 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10931 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10932 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10933 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10934 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10935 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10936 }
10937
10938 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */